jtag/ftdi: switch to command 'adapter serial'
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi.
2375 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2376 hla, jlink, kitprog, presto, st-link, vsllink, xds110.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @section Interface Drivers
2380
2381 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2382 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2383 available at run time.
2384
2385 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2386 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2387 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2388 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2389
2390 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2391 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2392 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2396 Displays status of RTCK option.
2397 Optionally sets that option first.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2402 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2403 This has one driver-specific command:
2404
2405 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2406 Logs some status
2407 @end deffn
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2411 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2412 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2413 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2414 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2415 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2419 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2420 or v2 (USB bulk).
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2423 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2424 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2425 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2426 @example
2427 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2428 @end example
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2432 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2433
2434 @itemize @minus
2435 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2436 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2437 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2438 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2439 @end itemize
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2443 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2444 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2445 interface string or for user class interface.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2516 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2517 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2521 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2522 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2523 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2524 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2525 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2526 and initially asserted reset signals.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2530 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2531 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2532 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2533 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2534 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2535 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2536 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2537 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2538 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2539 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2540
2541 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2542 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2543 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2544 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2545 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2546 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2547
2548 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2549 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2550 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2551 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2552 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2553 are always driven by the FTDI.
2554
2555 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2556 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2557 @var{name}.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2561 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2562 @itemize @minus
2563 @item @option{0}, drive low
2564 @item @option{1}, drive high
2565 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2566 @end itemize
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2570 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2574 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2575
2576 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2577 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2578 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2579 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2582 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2583 @end itemize
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2587 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2588
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2592 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2593 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2594 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2595
2596 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2597 @itemize @minus
2598 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2599 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2600 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2601 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2602 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2603 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2604 @end itemize
2605
2606 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2607 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2608 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2609 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2610 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2611 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2612 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2613 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2614
2615 FT232R
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item bit 7 - RI
2618 @item bit 6 - DCD
2619 @item bit 5 - DSR
2620 @item bit 4 - DTR
2621 @item bit 3 - CTS
2622 @item bit 2 - RTS
2623 @item bit 1 - RXD
2624 @item bit 0 - TXD
2625 @end itemize
2626
2627 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2628 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2631 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2632 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2636 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2637 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2641 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2645 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2649 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2653 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2657 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2661 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2665 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2666 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2667 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2668 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2669 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2670 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2671 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2672 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2673 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2679 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2680 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2681 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2682
2683 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2684 processors which are being simulated.
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2687 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2688 sockets instead of TCP.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2692 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2693 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2697 something like:
2698
2699 @example
2700 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2701 remote_bitbang port 3335
2702 remote_bitbang host foobar
2703 @end example
2704
2705 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2706 named mysocket:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 0
2711 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2712 @end example
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2716 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2717 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2718 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2721 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2722 default values are used.
2723 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2724 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2725 @example
2726 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2727 @end example
2728 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2729 @example
2730 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2735 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2736 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2737 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2738 target board.
2739
2740 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2741 @example
2742 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2743 reset_config srst_only
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2748 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2749 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2750 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2754 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2755 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2761 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2762 This has one driver-specific command:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2765 Display either the address of the I/O port
2766 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2767 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2768 This is a write-once setting.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @end deffn
2771
2772 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2773 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2774 transports.
2775
2776 @quotation Compatibility Note
2777 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2778 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2779 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2780 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2781 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2782 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2783 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2784 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2785 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2786 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2787 @end quotation
2788
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2790 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2791 states.
2792 @end deffn
2793 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2794 Display free device internal memory.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2797 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2798 command version.
2799 @end deffn
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2801 Display the device configuration.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2804 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2805 power state.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2808 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2811 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2812 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2813 IP configuration.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2816 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2817 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2820 Reset the current configuration.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2823 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2826 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2827 pairs.
2828
2829 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2830 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2831 @example
2832 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2836 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2837 pairs.
2838
2839 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2842 77a90000
2843 @end example
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2846 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2847 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2848 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2849 the serial number instead, if possible.
2850
2851 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2854 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2855 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2856
2857 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2858 @end deffn
2859 @end deffn
2860
2861 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2862 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2863 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2864 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2865 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2866 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2867 configuration script.
2868
2869 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2870 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2871 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2872 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2873 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2874
2875 Known limitations:
2876 @itemize @bullet
2877 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2878 and 2.7 MHz.
2879 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2880 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2881 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2882 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2883 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2884 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2885 communications with the target.
2886 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2887 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2888 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2889 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2890 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2891 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2892 @end itemize
2893
2894 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2895 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2896 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2900 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2901 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2902 @end deffn
2903
2904 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2905 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2906 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2907 target as a side-effect.
2908 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2909 @end deffn
2910
2911 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2912 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2913 version, and target voltage.
2914 @end deffn
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2918 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2919 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2920 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2921 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2922
2923 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2924 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2925 This is a write-once setting.
2926 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2927
2928 @itemize @minus
2929 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2930 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2931 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2932 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2933 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2934 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2935 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2936 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2937 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2938 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2939 some versions of
2940 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2941 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2942 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2943 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2944 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2945 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2946 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2947 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2948 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2949 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2950 @end itemize
2951 @end deffn
2952
2953 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2954 Display either the address of the I/O port
2955 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2956 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2957 This is a write-once setting.
2958
2959 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2960 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2961 you may encounter a problem.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2965 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2966 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2967 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2968 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2969 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2970
2971 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2972 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2973 @quotation Tip
2974 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2975 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2976 @example
2977 > parport toggling_time 1000
2978 > adapter speed 500
2979 @end example
2980 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2981 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2982 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2983 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2984 large set of samples.
2985 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2986 @example
2987 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2988 @end example
2989 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2990 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2991
2992 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2993 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2994 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2995 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2996 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2997 be conservative.
2998 @end quotation
2999 @end deffn
3000
3001 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3002 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3003 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3007 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3008
3009 @example
3010 adapter driver parport
3011 parport port 0x278
3012 parport cable wiggler
3013 @end example
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3017 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3018 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3019 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3020 @end deffn
3021 @end deffn
3022
3023 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3024 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3028 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3032 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3033
3034 @quotation Note
3035 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3036 which are not currently documented here.
3037 @end quotation
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @anchor{hla_interface}
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3042 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3043 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3044 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3045
3046 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3047 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3048 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3049 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3050 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3051 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3052
3053 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3054 Currently Not Supported.
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3058 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3062 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3066 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3067 @end deffn
3068
3069 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3070 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3071 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3072
3073 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3074 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3075 ST-LINK server software module}.
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3079 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3080 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3081 @end deffn
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3085 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3086 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3087 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3088 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3089
3090 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3091 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3092 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3093 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3094
3095 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3096 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3097
3098 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3099 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3100 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3101
3102 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3103 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3104 ST-LINK server software module}.
3105
3106 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3110 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3114 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3118 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3119 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3120
3121 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3122 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3123 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3124 the target's supply voltage.
3125 @example
3126 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3127 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3128 @end example
3129 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3130 @example
3131 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3132 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3133 3.24891518738
3134 @end example
3135 @end deffn
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3139 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3140 @end deffn
3141
3142 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3143 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3144 @end deffn
3145
3146 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3147 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3148 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3149 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3150 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3151
3152 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3153 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3154 XDS110 found will be used.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3158 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3159 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3160 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3164 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3165 version).
3166 @end deffn
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3170 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3171 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3172 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3173 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3174
3175 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3178 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3179
3180 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3181 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3182
3183 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3184
3185 @end deffn
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3189 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3190 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3191
3192 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3193 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3194 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3195 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3196 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3197 configuration on exit.
3198
3199 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3200
3201 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3202 pinout.
3203
3204 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3205 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3206 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3207 individually.
3208 @end deffn
3209
3210 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3211 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3212 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3216 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3217 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3221 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3222 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3226 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3227 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3231 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3232 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3233 @end deffn
3234
3235 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3236 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3237 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3241 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3242 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3246 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3247 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3248 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3252 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3256 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3260 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3261 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3265 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3266 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3267 list can be found in the
3268 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3274 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3275 of the one which is most popular.
3276
3277 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3278
3279 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3280 pinout.
3281
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284
3285 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3286 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3287 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3288
3289 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3290 @end deffn
3291
3292
3293 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3294 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3295 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3296
3297 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3298 @end deffn
3299
3300
3301 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3302 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3303 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3304
3305 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3306 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3307 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3308
3309 @itemize @minus
3310 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3311 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3312 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3313 @end itemize
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3317 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3318 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3319 @end deffn
3320 @end deffn
3321
3322
3323 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3324 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3325 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3326 DPI server interface.
3327
3328 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3329 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3333 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3334 @end deffn
3335 @end deffn
3336
3337
3338 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3339
3340 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3341 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3342
3343 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3344 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3345
3346 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3347 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3348 @example
3349 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3350 @end example
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3354 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3355 @example
3356 buspirate speed normal
3357 @end example
3358 @end deffn
3359
3360 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3361 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3362 @itemize @minus
3363 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3364 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3365 @end itemize
3366 For example:
3367 @example
3368 buspirate mode normal
3369 @end example
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3373 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3374 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3375 For example:
3376 @example
3377 buspirate pullup 0
3378 @end example
3379 @end deffn
3380
3381 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3382 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3383 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3384 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3385 @example
3386 buspirate vreg 0
3387 @end example
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3391 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3392 @end deffn
3393 @example
3394 buspirate led 1
3395 @end example
3396
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399
3400 @section Transport Configuration
3401 @cindex Transport
3402 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3403 and the debug adapter you are using,
3404 several transports may be available to
3405 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3406 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3407 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3408 version of OpenOCD.
3409 @end deffn
3410
3411 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3412 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3413
3414 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3415 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3416 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3417 adapter's driver).
3418
3419 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3420 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3421 supported by the debug adapter.
3422
3423 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3424 transport, if any.
3425 @end deffn
3426
3427 @subsection JTAG Transport
3428 @cindex JTAG
3429 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3430 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3431 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3432 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3433 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3434 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3435
3436 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3437 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3438 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3439 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3440 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3441
3442 @subsection SWD Transport
3443 @cindex SWD
3444 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3445 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3446 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3447 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3448 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3449 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3450 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3451
3452 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3453 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3454 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3455 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3456 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3457
3458 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3459 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3460 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3461 expected to change.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464 @subsection SPI Transport
3465 @cindex SPI
3466 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3467 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3468 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3469 solution for flash programming.
3470
3471 @anchor{swimtransport}
3472 @subsection SWIM Transport
3473 @cindex SWIM
3474 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3475 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3476 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3477 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3478
3479 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3480
3481 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3482
3483 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3484 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3485 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3486 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3487 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3488
3489 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3490 @section JTAG Speed
3491 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3492 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3493 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3494 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3495 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3496 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3497 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3498 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3499 power management software that may be active.
3500
3501 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3502 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3503 target event handler.
3504 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3505 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3506 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3507 sets up those clocks).
3508 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3509 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3510 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3511 in the target config file.
3512 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3513 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3514 config file instead.
3515 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3516 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3517 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3518
3519 @example
3520 jtag_rclk 3000
3521 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3522 @end example
3523
3524 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3525 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3526 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3527 may not be the fastest solution.
3528
3529 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3530 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3531 which support adaptive clocking.
3532
3533 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3534 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3535 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3536 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3537 than the speed specified.
3538
3539 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3540 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3541 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3542 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3543
3544 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3545 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3546 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3547 JTAG clocking after setup.
3548 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3549 If the interface device can not
3550 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3551 @end deffn
3552
3553 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3554 @cindex adaptive clocking
3555 @cindex RTCK
3556 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3557 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3558 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3559 @example
3560 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3561 jtag_rclk 3000
3562 @end example
3563 @end defun
3564
3565 @node Reset Configuration
3566 @chapter Reset Configuration
3567 @cindex Reset Configuration
3568
3569 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3570 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3571 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3572 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3573 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3574 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3575 Please see the various board files for examples.
3576
3577 @quotation Note
3578 To maintainers and integrators:
3579 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3580 Normally the board configuration file
3581 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3582 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3583
3584 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3585 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3586 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3587 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3588 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3589 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3590 @end quotation
3591
3592 @section Types of Reset
3593
3594 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3595 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3596 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3597
3598 @itemize @bullet
3599 @item
3600 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3601 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3602 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3603 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3604 @item
3605 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3606 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3607 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3608 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3609 @item
3610 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3611 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3612 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3613 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3614 @item
3615 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3616 several other types of reset.
3617 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3618 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3619 There may be individual module resets.
3620 @end itemize
3621
3622 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3623 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3624 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3625 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3626 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3627 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3628 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3629 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3630 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3631
3632 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3633 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3634
3635 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3636 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3637 common issues are:
3638
3639 @itemize @bullet
3640
3641 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3642 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3643 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3644 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3645 when either of those signals is not connected.
3646 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3647 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3648 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3649 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3650
3651 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3652 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3653 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3654 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3655
3656 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3657 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3658 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3659 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3660 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3661 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3662 hardware debouncing.
3663 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3664 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3665
3666 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3667 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3668 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3669 to use push/pull output drivers.
3670 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3671 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3672 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3673 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3674
3675 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3676 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3677 issues (not limited to errata).
3678 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3679 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3680 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3681 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3682 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3683 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 There can also be other issues.
3687 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3688 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3689 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3690 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3691 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3692 Agreement (NDA).
3693
3694 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3695 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3696 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3697
3698 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3699 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3700
3701 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3702
3703 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3704 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3705 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3706 allowing it to be deasserted.
3707 @end deffn
3708
3709 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3710 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3711 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3712 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3713 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3714 @end deffn
3715
3716 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3717 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3718 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3719 allowing it to be deasserted.
3720 @end deffn
3721
3722 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3723 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3724 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3725 @end deffn
3726
3727 @anchor{reset_config}
3728 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3729 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3730 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3731 configuration scripts.
3732
3733 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3734 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3735 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3736 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3737 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3738 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3739 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3740 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3741
3742 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3743 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3744 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3745 -- may be specified at a time.
3746 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3747 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3748 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3749 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3750 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3751
3752 @itemize
3753 @item
3754 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3755 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3756 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3757 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3758 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3759
3760 @quotation Tip
3761 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3762 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3763 @end quotation
3764
3765 @item
3766 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3767 signal implementations.
3768 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3769 indicating everything behaves normally.
3770 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3771 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3772 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3773 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3774 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3775 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3776 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3777
3778 @item
3779 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3780 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3781 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3782 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3783 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3784 while SRST is asserted.
3785 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3786 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3787
3788 @item
3789 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3790 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3791 is required to use this option.
3792 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3793 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3794 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3795 be asserted before any target connection.
3796 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3797 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3798 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3799 @end itemize
3800
3801 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3802 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3803 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3804 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3805 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3806
3807 @itemize
3808 @item
3809 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3810 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3811 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3812 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3813
3814 @item
3815 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3816 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3817 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3818 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3819 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3820 @end itemize
3821 @end deffn
3822
3823 @section Custom Reset Handling
3824 @cindex events
3825
3826 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3827 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3828 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3829 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3830 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3831 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3832
3833 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3834 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3835 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3836 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3837 want to reset everything at once.
3838
3839 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3840 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3841 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3842 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3843 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3844 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3845 needs special attention.
3846
3847 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3848 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3849 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3850 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3851 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3852 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3853 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3854 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3855 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3856
3857 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3858 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3859 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3860 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3861 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3862
3863 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3864 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3865 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3866 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3867 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3868 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3869 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3870 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3871 or potentially some other value.
3872
3873 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3874 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3875 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3876 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3877 (or their associated targets)
3878 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3879
3880 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3881 they return.
3882 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3883 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3884 @end deffn
3885
3886 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3887 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3888 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3889 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3890 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3891 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3892 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3893 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3894 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3895 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3896 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3897 @end deffn
3898
3899 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3900 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3901 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3902 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3903 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3904 @end deffn
3905
3906
3907 @node TAP Declaration
3908 @chapter TAP Declaration
3909 @cindex TAP declaration
3910 @cindex TAP configuration
3911
3912 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3913 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3914
3915 @itemize @bullet
3916 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3917 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3918 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3919 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3920 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3921 start running that code.
3922 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3923 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3924 and missing connections.
3925 @end itemize
3926
3927 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3928 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3929 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3930 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3931 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3932
3933 @section Scan Chains
3934 @cindex scan chain
3935
3936 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3937 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3938 They also need to be added to
3939 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3940 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3941 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3942 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3943 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3944 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3945 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3946 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3947
3948 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3949 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3950 command, presented in the next chapter.
3951 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3952 debugging targets.)
3953 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3954
3955 @verbatim
3956 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3957 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3958 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3959 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3960 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3961 @end verbatim
3962
3963 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3964 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3965 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3966 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3967 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3968 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3969 until they are told to do so.
3970
3971 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3972 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3973 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3974 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3975
3976 @example
3977 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3978 @end example
3979
3980 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3981 by a given chip.
3982 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3983 and so forth.
3984 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3985 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3986 both inside a single chip and between them.
3987 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3988
3989 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3990 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3991 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3992 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3993 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3994 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3995 includes commands something like this:
3996
3997 @example
3998 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3999 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4000 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4001 @end example
4002
4003 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4004 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4005 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4006
4007 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4008 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4009 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4010 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4011 @example
4012 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4013 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4014 @}
4015 @end example
4016 @end deffn
4017
4018 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4019 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4020 and their status.
4021 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4022 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4023 but systems with a JTAG router can
4024 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4028 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4029
4030 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4031 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4032
4033 @section TAP Names
4034 @cindex dotted name
4035
4036 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4037 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4038 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4039 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4040 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4041 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4042 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4043 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4044
4045 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4046 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4047 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4048
4049 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4050
4051 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4052 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4053 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4054
4055 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4056 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4057 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4058 overridable.
4059
4060 @cindex TAP naming convention
4061 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4062 and should follow this convention:
4063
4064 @itemize @bullet
4065 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4066 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4067 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4068 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4069 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4070 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4071 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4072 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4073 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4074 with a single TAP;
4075 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4076 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4077 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4078 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4079 @end itemize
4080
4081 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4082
4083 @itemize @bullet
4084 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4085 @*The length in bits of the
4086 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4087 @end itemize
4088
4089 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4090
4091 @itemize @bullet
4092 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4093 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4094 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4095 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4096 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4097 (the TAP is linked in).
4098 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4099 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4100 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4101 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4102 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4103 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4104 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4105 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4106 values that were found but not included in the list.
4107
4108 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4109 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4110 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4111 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4112 hardware to find these values.
4113 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4114 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4115 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4116 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4117 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4118 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4119 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4120 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4121 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4122 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4123 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4124 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4125 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4126 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4127 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4128 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4129 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4130 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4131 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4132 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4133 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4134 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4135 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4136 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4137 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4138 @end itemize
4139 @end deffn
4140
4141 @section Other TAP commands
4142
4143 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4144 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4145 @end deffn
4146
4147 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4148 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4149 At this writing this TAP attribute
4150 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4151 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4152 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4153 See the next section for information about the available events.
4154
4155 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4156 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4157 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4158 @end deffn
4159
4160 @section TAP Events
4161 @cindex events
4162 @cindex TAP events
4163
4164 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4165 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4166 The other applies to debugger targets,
4167 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4168
4169 The TAP events currently defined are:
4170
4171 @itemize @bullet
4172 @item @b{post-reset}
4173 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4174 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4175 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4176 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4177 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4178
4179 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4180 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4181 of any particular target.
4182 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4183 @item @b{setup}
4184 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4185 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4186 @item @b{tap-disable}
4187 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4188 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4189 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4190 @item @b{tap-enable}
4191 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4192 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4193 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4194 @end itemize
4195
4196 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4197 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4198 contents to be accurate), you might:
4199
4200 @example
4201 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4202 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4203 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4204 @}
4205 @end example
4206
4207
4208 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4209 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4210 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4211 @cindex jrc
4212
4213 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4214 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4215 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4216 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4217 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4218
4219 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4220 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4221 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4222 be visible.
4223 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4224 ignores, such as:
4225
4226 @itemize
4227 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4228 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4229 TAPs receive new instructions.
4230 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4231 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4232 @end itemize
4233
4234 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4235 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4236 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4237 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4238
4239 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4240 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4241
4242 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4243 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4244 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4245 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4246 should define TAP event handlers using
4247 code that looks something like this:
4248
4249 @example
4250 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4251 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4252 @}
4253 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4254 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4255 @}
4256 @end example
4257
4258 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4259
4260 @example
4261 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4262 @end example
4263
4264 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4265 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4266 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4267 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4268
4269 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4270 If necessary, disables the tap
4271 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4272 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4273 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4274 and "0" if it is disabled.
4275 @end deffn
4276
4277 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4278 If necessary, enables the tap
4279 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4280 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4281 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4282 and "0" if it is disabled.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4286 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4287 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4288 and "0" if it is disabled.
4289
4290 @quotation Note
4291 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4292 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4293 @end quotation
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @anchor{autoprobing}
4297 @section Autoprobing
4298 @cindex autoprobe
4299 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4300
4301 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4302 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4303 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4304 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4305
4306 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4307 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4308 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4309 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4310 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4311 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4312 right when they come out of reset).
4313
4314 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4315
4316 @example
4317 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4318 reset_config trst_and_srst
4319 jtag_rclk 8
4320 @end example
4321
4322 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4323 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4324
4325 @enumerate
4326 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4327 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4328 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4329 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4330 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4331 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4332 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4333 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4334 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4335 that is discovered.
4336 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4337 register, it will report it.
4338 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4339 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4340 @end enumerate
4341
4342 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4343 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4344 that's a bit more complex:
4345
4346 @example
4347 clock speed 8 kHz
4348 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4349 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4350 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4351 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4352 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4353 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4354 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4355 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4356 @end example
4357
4358 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4359 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4360 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4361 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4362 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4363 and so forth.
4364
4365 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4366 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4367 @cindex DAP declaration
4368
4369 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4370 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4371 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4372 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4373 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4374
4375 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4376
4377 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4378 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4379 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4380 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4381 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4382
4383 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4384
4385 @itemize @bullet
4386 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4387 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4388 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4389 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4390 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4391
4392 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4393 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4394 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4395 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4396 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4397 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4398
4399 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4400 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4401 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4402 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4403 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4404 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4405 @end itemize
4406 @end deffn
4407
4408 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4409 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4410 for TCL scripting.
4411 @end deffn
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4414 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4415 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4419 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4420 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4421 initialization, too.
4422 @end deffn
4423
4424 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4425
4426 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4427 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4428 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4429 @end deffn
4430
4431 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4432 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4433 @end deffn
4434
4435 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4436 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4437 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4438 or set a new value @var{value}.
4439 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4440 @end deffn
4441
4442 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4443 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4444 @end deffn
4445
4446 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4447 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4448 value @var{value}.
4449
4450 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4451 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4452 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4453
4454 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4455 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4456 @end deffn
4457
4458 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4459 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4460 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4461 @end deffn
4462
4463 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4464 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4465 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4466 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4467 @end deffn
4468
4469 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4470 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4471
4472 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4473 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4474 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4475 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4476 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4477 for details.
4478
4479 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4480 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4481 the pattern:
4482 @example
4483 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4484 @end example
4485
4486 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4487 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4488 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4489 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4490 @example
4491 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4492 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4493 @end example
4494
4495 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4496 @example
4497 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4498 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4499 @end example
4500
4501 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4502 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4503
4504 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4505 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4506 example with a proper dap name:
4507 @example
4508 xxx.dap apcsw default
4509 @end example
4510 @end deffn
4511
4512 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4513 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4514 Disabled by default
4515 @end deffn
4516
4517
4518 @node CPU Configuration
4519 @chapter CPU Configuration
4520 @cindex GDB target
4521
4522 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4523 You can also access these targets without GDB
4524 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4525 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4526 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4527 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4528
4529 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4530 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4531
4532 @section Target List
4533 @cindex target, current
4534 @cindex target, list
4535
4536 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4537 where each member has a name.
4538 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4539 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4540 (plural!) command.
4541 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4542 look like with more than one:
4543 @verbatim
4544 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4545 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4546 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4547 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4548 @end verbatim
4549
4550 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4551 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4552 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4553 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4554 space seen by that current target.
4555 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4556 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4557 are examples; and there are many more.
4558
4559 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4560
4561 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4562 Returns the name of the current target.
4563 @end deffn
4564
4565 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4566 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4567 @example
4568 foreach t [target names] @{
4569 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4570 @}
4571 @end example
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4575 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4576
4577 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4578 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4579 command names are singular.}
4580
4581 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4582 targets in a user friendly form.
4583
4584 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4585 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4586 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4587 @end deffn
4588
4589 @section Target CPU Types
4590 @cindex target type
4591 @cindex CPU type
4592
4593 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4594 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4595 when calling @command{target create}.
4596 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4597 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4598 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4599 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4600 what core-specific commands may be available
4601 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4602 and more.
4603
4604 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4605 since there's a command to list them.
4606
4607 @anchor{targettypes}
4608 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4609 Lists all supported target types.
4610 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4611
4612 @itemize @bullet
4613 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4614 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4615 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4616 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4617 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4618 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4619 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4620 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4621 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4622 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4623 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4624 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4625 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4626 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4627 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4628 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4629 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4630 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4631 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4632 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4633 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4634 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4635 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4636 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4637 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4638 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4639 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4640 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4641 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4642 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4643 support for new CPUs.
4644 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4645 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4646 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4647 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4648 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4649 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4650 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4651 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4652 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4653 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4654 @itemize @minus
4655 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4656 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4657 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4658 @end itemize
4659 And two debug interfaces cores:
4660 @itemize @minus
4661 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4662 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4663 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4664 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4665 @end itemize
4666 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4667 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4668 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4669 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4670 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4671 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4672 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4673 @end itemize
4674 @end deffn
4675
4676 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4677 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4678 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4679 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4680 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4681 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4682 reflect design generations;
4683 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4684 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4685
4686 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4687 @section Target Configuration
4688
4689 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4690 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4691 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4692 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4693 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4694
4695 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4696 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4697 optional parts.
4698 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4699 command, created as part of target creation.
4700
4701 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4702 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4703 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4704 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4705 to be much more board-specific.
4706 The key steps you use might look something like this
4707
4708 @example
4709 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4710 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4711 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4712 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4713 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4714 @end example
4715
4716 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4717 on-chip SRAM.
4718 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4719 writes to target memory;
4720 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4721 GDB memory checksumming;
4722 and more.
4723
4724 @quotation Warning
4725 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4726 inaccessible when application code
4727 (such as an operating system)
4728 enables or disables the MMU.
4729 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4730 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4731 easy access to other addresses needed.
4732 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4733 @end quotation
4734
4735 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4736 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4737 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4738 controllers.
4739 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4740 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4741 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4742
4743 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4744 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4745 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4746 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4747 purposes including additional configuration.
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4751 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4752 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4753 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4754
4755 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4756 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4757 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4758 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4759 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4760 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4761 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4762
4763 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4764 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4765 @end itemize
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4769 The options accepted by this command may also be
4770 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4771 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4772 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4773
4774 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4775 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4776 and changing its endianness.
4777
4778 @itemize @bullet
4779
4780 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4781 used to access this target.
4782
4783 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4784 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4785 create and manage DAP instances.
4786
4787 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4788 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4789
4790 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4791 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4792 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4793 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4794 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4795 same event name assigns only one handler.
4796
4797 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4798 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4799
4800 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4801 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4802 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4803 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4804 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4805 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4806 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4807
4808 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4809 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4810 or virtual address is being used.
4811
4812 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4813 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4814
4815 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4816 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4817 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4818 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4819 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4820
4821 @anchor{rtostype}
4822 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4823 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4824 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4825 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4826 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4827 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4828
4829 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4830 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4831 access the target for debugging.
4832
4833 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4834 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4835 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4836 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4837
4838 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4839 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4840 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4841 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4842 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4843
4844 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4845 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4846 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4847 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4848 command @command{gdb_port}.
4849 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4850
4851 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4852 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4853 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4854 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4855 @end itemize
4856 @end deffn
4857
4858 @section Other $target_name Commands
4859 @cindex object command
4860
4861 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4862 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4863
4864 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4865 Once a button is created a button
4866 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4867 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4868 configure it like this:
4869
4870 @example
4871 # Create
4872 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4873 # Modify
4874 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4875 # Query
4876 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4877 # Report
4878 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4879 @end example
4880
4881 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4882 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4883
4884 @example
4885 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4886 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4887 @end example
4888
4889 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4890
4891 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4892 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4893 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4894 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4895 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4896 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4897 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4898 They are not otherwise documented here.
4899 @end deffn
4900
4901 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4902 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4903 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4904 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4905 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4906 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4907 the target side uses raw memory.
4908
4909 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4910 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4911 The script orientation comes from working with data
4912 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4913 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4914 and neither store nor return those values.
4915
4916 @itemize
4917 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4918 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4919 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4920 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4921 @end itemize
4922 @end deffn
4923
4924 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4925 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4926 @command{$target_name configure}
4927 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4928 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4929 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4930 There are a few special cases:
4931
4932 @itemize @bullet
4933 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4934 event named @var{event_name}.
4935 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4936 two parameters.
4937 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4938 This is a special case because this is set using
4939 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4940 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4941 @end itemize
4942
4943 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4944 all the targets you might use something like this:
4945
4946 @example
4947 foreach name [target names] @{
4948 set y [$name cget -endian]
4949 set z [$name cget -type]
4950 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4951 $x $name $y $z]
4952 @}
4953 @end example
4954 @end deffn
4955
4956 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4957 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4958 Displays the current target state:
4959 @code{debug-running},
4960 @code{halted},
4961 @code{reset},
4962 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4963 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4964 @end deffn
4965
4966 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4967 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4968 currently associated with this target.
4969 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4970 @end deffn
4971
4972 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4973 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4974 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4975 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4979 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4980 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4981 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4982 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4983 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4984 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4985 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4986 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4987 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4988 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4989 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4990 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4991 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4992 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4993 @end deffn
4994
4995 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4996 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4997 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4998 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4999 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5000 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5001 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5002 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5003 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5004 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5005 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5006 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5007 @end deffn
5008
5009 @anchor{targetevents}
5010 @section Target Events
5011 @cindex target events
5012 @cindex events
5013 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5014 For example:
5015 @itemize @bullet
5016 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5017 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5018 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5019 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5020 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5021 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5022 to set up system clocks or
5023 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5024 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5025 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5026 @end itemize
5027
5028 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5029 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5030 @command{target create ... -event}.
5031
5032 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5033 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5034 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5035
5036 @example
5037 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5038 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5039 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5040 @}
5041 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5042 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5043 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5044 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5045 @}
5046 @end example
5047
5048 The following target events are defined:
5049
5050 @itemize @bullet
5051 @item @b{debug-halted}
5052 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5053 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5054 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5055 @item @b{early-halted}
5056 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5057 @item @b{examine-start}
5058 @* Before target examine is called.
5059 @item @b{examine-end}
5060 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5061 @item @b{examine-fail}
5062 @* After target examine fails.
5063 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5064 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5065 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5066 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5067 connect GDB to running target.
5068 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5069 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5070 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5071 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5072 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5073 is in RAM or read only memory.
5074 Default is @code{halt}
5075 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5076 @* When GDB disconnects
5077 @item @b{gdb-end}
5078 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5079 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5080 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5081 @code{reset init})
5082 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5083 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5084 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5085 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5086 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5087 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5088 @item @b{gdb-start}
5089 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5090 @item @b{halted}
5091 @* The target has halted
5092 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5093 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5094 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5095 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5096 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5097 @item @b{reset-assert}
5098 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5099 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5100 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5101 it instead of asserting SRST.
5102 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5103 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5104 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5105 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5106 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5107 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5108 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5109 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5110 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5111 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5112 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5113 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5114 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5115 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5116 released on the scan chain.
5117 @item @b{reset-end}
5118 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5119 @item @b{reset-init}
5120 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5121 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5122
5123 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5124 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5125 multiplexing, and so on.
5126 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5127 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5128 @item @b{reset-start}
5129 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5130 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5131
5132 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5133 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5134 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5135 @item @b{resume-start}
5136 @* Before any target is resumed
5137 @item @b{resume-end}
5138 @* After all targets have resumed
5139 @item @b{resumed}
5140 @* Target has resumed
5141 @item @b{step-start}
5142 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5143 @item @b{step-end}
5144 @* After single-step has completed
5145 @item @b{trace-config}
5146 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5147 @end itemize
5148
5149 @quotation Note
5150 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5151 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5152 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5153 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5154 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5155 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5156 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5157 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5158 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5159 check if the core has changed status.
5160 @end quotation
5161
5162 @node Flash Commands
5163 @chapter Flash Commands
5164
5165 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5166 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5167 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5168 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5169 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5170 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5171 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5172 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5173 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5174
5175 Flash Steps:
5176 @enumerate
5177 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5178 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5179 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5180 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5181 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5182 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5183 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5184 @item GDB Flashing
5185 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5186 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5187 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5188 @end enumerate
5189
5190 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5191 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5192 so that it can't boot.
5193 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5194 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5195
5196 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5197 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5198 @cindex flash configuration
5199
5200 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5201 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5202 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5203 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5204 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5205 see the driver-specific documentation.
5206
5207 @itemize @bullet
5208 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5209 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5210 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5211 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5212 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5213 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5214 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5215 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5216 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5217 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5218 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5219 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5220 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5221 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5222 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5223 commands to the flash controller.
5224 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5225 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5226 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5227 for more information.
5228 @end itemize
5229 @quotation Note
5230 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5231 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5232 @end quotation
5233 @end deffn
5234
5235 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5236 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5237 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5238 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5239 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5240 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5244 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5245 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5246 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5247 @end deffn
5248
5249 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5250 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5251 depends on the flash type.
5252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5253 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5254 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5255 but most don't bother.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5259
5260 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5261 begins.
5262
5263 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5264 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5265 until the programming session is finished.
5266
5267 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5268 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5269
5270 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5271
5272 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5273 @cindex flash erasing
5274 @cindex flash reading
5275 @cindex flash writing
5276 @cindex flash programming
5277 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5278
5279 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5280 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5281 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5282 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5283 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5284
5285 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5286 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5287 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5288 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5289 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5290
5291 @quotation Note
5292 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5293 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5294 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5295 back to a flash bank.
5296 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5297 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5298 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5299 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5300 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5301 @end quotation
5302
5303 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5304 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5305 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5306 disabled first.
5307 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5308 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5309 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5310
5311 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5312 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5313 up to and including @var{last}.
5314 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5315 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5316 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5318 @end deffn
5319
5320 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5321 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5322 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5323 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5324 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5325 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5326 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5327 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5328 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5329 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5330 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5331 before erase starts.
5332 @end deffn
5333
5334 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5335 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5336 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5337 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5338 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5339 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5340 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5341 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5342 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5343 before issuing this command.
5344 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5345 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5346 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5347 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5348 @end deffn
5349 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5352 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5353 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5354 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5355 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5356 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5357 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5358 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5359 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5360 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5361 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5362 @end deffn
5363
5364 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5365 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5366 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5367 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5369 @end deffn
5370
5371 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5372 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5373 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5374 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5375 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5376 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5380 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5381 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5382 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5383 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5384 @end deffn
5385
5386 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5387 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5388 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5389 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5390 to the base address for each section in the image.
5391 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5392 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5393 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5394 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5395 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5396 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5397 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5398 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5399 each image section.
5400
5401 @quotation Warning
5402 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5403 data you want to preserve.
5404 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5405 sections might be erased with no notice.
5406 @itemize
5407 @item
5408 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5409 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5410 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5411 @item
5412 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5413 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5414 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5415 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5416 @end itemize
5417 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5418 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5419 @end quotation
5420
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5424 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5425 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5426 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5427 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5428 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5429 ordinary memory reads.
5430 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5431 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5432 check for successful programming.
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @section Other Flash commands
5436 @cindex flash protection
5437
5438 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5439 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5440 and display that status.
5441 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5445 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5446 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5447
5448 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5449 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5450 and possibly stale information.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @anchor{flashprotect}
5454 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5455 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5456 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5457 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5458 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5459 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5461 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5462 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5463 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5467 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5468 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5469 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5470 @end deffn
5471
5472 @anchor{program}
5473 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5474 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5475 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5476 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5480 @section Flash Driver List
5481 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5482 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5483 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5484
5485 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5486 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5487 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5488
5489 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5490
5491 @itemize
5492 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5493 @end itemize
5494
5495 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5496 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5497 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5498 @example
5499 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5500 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5501 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5502 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5503 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5504 @end example
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @subsection External Flash
5508
5509 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5510 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5511 @cindex CFI
5512 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5513 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5514 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5515 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5516 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5517 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5518 configure a bus and its timings), or
5519 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5520 on the flash chip.
5521 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5522 speed up operation.
5523
5524 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5525
5526 @itemize
5527 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5528 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5529 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5530 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5531 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5532 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5533 @end itemize
5534
5535 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5536 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5537
5538 @example
5539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5540 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5541 @end example
5542
5543 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5544 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5545 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5546
5547 @example
5548 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5549 @end example
5550
5551 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5552 @end deffn
5553
5554 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5555 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5556 @cindex SPI
5557 @cindex jtagspi
5558 @cindex bscan_spi
5559 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5560 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5561 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5562 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5563 accessed through JTAG.
5564
5565 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5566 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5567 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5568 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5569 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5570 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5571
5572 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5573 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5574 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5575 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5576 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5577 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5578 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5579 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5580
5581 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5582 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5583 command, see below.
5584
5585 @itemize
5586 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5587 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5588 @var{USER1} instruction.
5589 @end itemize
5590
5591 @example
5592 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5593 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5595 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5596 @end example
5597
5598 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5599 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5600 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5601 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5602 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5603 @example
5604 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5605 @end example
5606 @end deffn
5607
5608 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5609 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5610 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5611 @example
5612 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5613 @end example
5614 @end deffn
5615
5616 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5617 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5618 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5619 @end deffn
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5623 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5624 @cindex xcf
5625 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5626 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5627 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5628 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5629 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5630
5631 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5632 command accepts additional parameters:
5633 @itemize
5634 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5635 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5636 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5637 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5638 in master mode.
5639 @end itemize
5640 @example
5641 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5642 @end example
5643 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5644 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5645 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5646 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5647 dedicated sector.
5648 @end deffn
5649
5650 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5651 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5652 button.
5653 @example
5654 xcf configure 0
5655 @end example
5656 @end deffn
5657
5658 Additional driver notes:
5659 @itemize
5660 @item Only single revision supported.
5661 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5662 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5663 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5664 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5665 @end itemize
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5669 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5670 @cindex SPIFI
5671 @cindex lpcspifi
5672 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5673 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5674 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5675
5676 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5677 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5678 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5679 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5680 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5681
5682 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5683 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5684 are configured by the driver.
5685
5686 @example
5687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5688 @end example
5689
5690 @end deffn
5691
5692 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5693 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5694 @cindex SMI
5695 @cindex stmsmi
5696 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5697 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5698 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5699 SPI flash devices.
5700 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5701 flash devices can be connected.
5702
5703 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5704 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5705 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5706 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5707 the flash content.
5708
5709 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5710 to identify the memory bank.
5711 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5712 flash size, are detected automatically.
5713
5714 @example
5715 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5716 @end example
5717
5718 @end deffn
5719
5720 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5721 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5722 @cindex QuadSPI
5723 @cindex OctoSPI
5724 @cindex stmqspi
5725 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5726 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5727 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5728 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5729 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5730 mode is not.
5731
5732 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5733 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5734 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5735 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5736
5737 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5738 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5739 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5740
5741 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5742 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5743 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5744 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5745 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5746 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5747
5748 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5749 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5750 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5751 should be avoided.
5752
5753 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5754 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5755 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5756 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5757 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5758 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5759
5760 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5761 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5762 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5763 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5764 persist across openocd invocations.
5765
5766 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5767 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5768 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5769 required (see 'set' command).
5770
5771 @example
5772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5773 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5774 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5775 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5776 @end example
5777
5778 There are three specific commands
5779 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5780 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5781 chip specific write protection engaged.
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5785 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5786 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5787 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5788 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5789 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5790
5791 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5792 which don't support an id command.
5793
5794 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5795 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5796 @end deffn
5797
5798 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5799 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5800 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5801 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5802 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5803
5804 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5805 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5806 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5807 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5808
5809 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5810
5811 To check basic communication settings, issue
5812 @example
5813 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5814 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5815 @end example
5816 for single flash mode or
5817 @example
5818 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5819 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5820 @end example
5821 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5822
5823 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5824 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5825 need a dummy address, e.g.
5826 @example
5827 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5828 @end example
5829 should return the status register contents.
5830
5831 @end deffn
5832
5833 @end deffn
5834
5835 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5836 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5837 Microcontroller platform.
5838
5839 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5840 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5841
5842 @example
5843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5844 @end example
5845
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5849 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5850 @cindex ath79
5851 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5852 chip selects.
5853 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5854 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5855 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5856 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5857 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5858 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5859
5860 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5861 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5862 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5863 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5864 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5865 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5866 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5867 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5868 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5869 with the default CS0.
5870 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5871 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5872 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5873
5874 @example
5875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5876
5877 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5878 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5879 # distinguish the banks.
5880 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5881 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5882 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5883 @end example
5884
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5888 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5889 @cindex fespi
5890
5891 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5892
5893 @example
5894 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5895 @end example
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5899
5900 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5901 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5902 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5903 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5904 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5905 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5906
5907 @example
5908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5909 @end example
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5913 @cindex ambiqmicro
5914 @cindex apollo
5915 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5916 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5917 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5918 with the target using SWD.
5919
5920 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5921 the device class of the MCU.
5922 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5923 to set up the flash banks.
5924 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5925 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5926
5927 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5928 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5929 and the second bank starts after the first.
5930
5931 @example
5932 # Flash bank 0
5933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5934 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5936 $_TARGETNAME
5937 @end example
5938
5939 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5940 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5941 are available to the user.
5942
5943 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5944
5945 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5946 Erase entire bank.
5947 @end deffn
5948 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5949 Erase device pages.
5950 @end deffn
5951 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5952 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5953 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5954 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5955 the flash.
5956 @end deffn
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @anchor{at91samd}
5960 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5961 @cindex at91samd
5962 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5963 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5964
5965 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5966
5967 The devices have one flash bank:
5968
5969 @example
5970 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5971 @end example
5972
5973 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5974 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5975 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5976 processor to be halted.
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5980 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5981 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5982 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5983 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5984 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5985
5986 @example
5987 at91samd set-security enable
5988 @end example
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5992 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5993 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5994 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5995 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5996 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5997 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5998 in order to disable this feature.
5999
6000 @example
6001 at91samd eeprom
6002 at91samd eeprom 1024
6003 @end example
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6007 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6008 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6009 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6010 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6011 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6012
6013 @example
6014 at91samd bootloader
6015 at91samd bootloader 16384
6016 @end example
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6020 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6021 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6022 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6023 @end deffn
6024
6025 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6026 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6027 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6028 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6029 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6030 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6031 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6032 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6033
6034 @example
6035 # Read user row
6036 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6037 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6038 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6039 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6040 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6041 # byte unchanged
6042 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6043 @end example
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @end deffn
6047
6048 @anchor{at91sam3}
6049 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6050 @cindex at91sam3
6051 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6052 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6053 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6054 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6055 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6056 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6057 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6058 chips are confirmed.}
6059
6060 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6061 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6062 the following fixed locations:
6063
6064 @example
6065 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6066 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6067 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6068 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6069 @end example
6070
6071 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6072 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6073 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6074
6075 @itemize
6076 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6077 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6078 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6079 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6080 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6081 @end itemize
6082
6083 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6084
6085 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6086 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6087 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6088 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6089 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6090 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6091 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6092
6093 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6094 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6098 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6099 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6100 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6101 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6102 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6103 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6104 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6108 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6109 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6110 @end deffn
6111 @end deffn
6112
6113 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6114 @cindex at91sam4
6115 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6116 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6117 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6118 @end deffn
6119
6120 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6121 @cindex at91sam4l
6122 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6123 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6124 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6125
6126 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6127 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6128 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6129 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6130 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6131 @end deffn
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @anchor{atsame5}
6135 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6136 @cindex atsame5
6137 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6138 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6139 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6140
6141 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6142 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6143 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6144
6145 @example
6146 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6147 @end example
6148
6149 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6150 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6151 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6152 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6153 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6154 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6155
6156 @example
6157 atsame5 bootloader
6158 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6159 @end example
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6163 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6164 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6165 processor to be halted.
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6169 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6170 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6171 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6175 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6176 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6177 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6178 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6179 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6180 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6181 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6182
6183 @example
6184 # Read
6185 >atsame5 userpage
6186 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6187 # Write
6188 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6189 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6190 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6191 # bytes)
6192 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6193 @end example
6194 @end deffn
6195
6196 @end deffn
6197
6198 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6199 @cindex atsamv
6200 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6201 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6202 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6203 @end deffn
6204
6205 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6206 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6207 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6208 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6209 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6210
6211 @example
6212 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6213 @end example
6214
6215 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6216 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6217
6218 @itemize
6219 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6220 @item @var{banks}
6221 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6222 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6223 @item @var{pages_size}
6224 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6225 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6226 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6227 @end itemize
6228
6229 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6230 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6231 will be autoconfigured.
6232 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6233
6234 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6235 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6236 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6237 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6238 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6239
6240 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6241 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6242 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6243 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6244 are not truly general purpose).
6245 @quotation Note
6246 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6247 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6248 @end quotation
6249 @end deffn
6250 @end deffn
6251
6252 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6253 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6254 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6255 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6259 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6260 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6261 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6262
6263 @example
6264 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6265 @end example
6266
6267 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6268 each single sector one by one.
6269
6270 @example
6271 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6272 @end example
6273
6274 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6278 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6279 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6280 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6281 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6282 starts at address 0.
6283
6284 @example
6285 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6286 @end example
6287 @end deffn
6288
6289 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6290 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6291 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6292 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6293 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6294 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6295 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6296 and programming the serial flash.
6297
6298 @example
6299 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6300 @end example
6301 @end deffn
6302
6303 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6304 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6305 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6306 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6307 autoconfigures itself.
6308 @example
6309 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6310 @end example
6311 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6312 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6313 this via the following command:
6314 @example
6315 efm32 debuglock num
6316 @end example
6317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6318 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6319 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6320 supported.}
6321 @end deffn
6322
6323 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6324 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6325 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6326 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6327 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6328 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6329
6330 @example
6331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6332 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6333 @end example
6334
6335 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6336 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6340 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6341 is an uncommon operation.}
6342 @end deffn
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6346 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6347 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6348 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6349 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6350 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6351 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6352
6353 @example
6354 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6355 @end example
6356 @end deffn
6357
6358 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6359 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6360 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6361 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6362 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6363 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6364 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6365 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6366 characters) ignored.
6367
6368 @example
6369 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6370 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6371 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6372 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6373 @end example
6374 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6375 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6376 @end deffn
6377
6378 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6379 @cindex kinetis
6380 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6381 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6382 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6383 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6384 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6385 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6386
6387 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6388 @itemize
6389 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6390 @end itemize
6391
6392 @example
6393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6394 @end example
6395
6396 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6397 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6398 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6399 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6400 @end deffn
6401
6402 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6403 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6404 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6405 set by 'flash protect' command.
6406 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6407 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6408 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6409 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6410 with the rest of a flash image.
6411 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6412 @end deffn
6413
6414 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6415 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6416 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6420 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6421 and examine-fail event.
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6425 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6426 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6427 @end deffn
6428
6429 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6430 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6431 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6432 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6433 command completes.
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6437 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6438 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6439 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6440 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6441
6442 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6443 Program Partition command.
6444
6445 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6446 Reset the device after partition setting.
6447
6448 Show partition size:
6449 @example
6450 kinetis nvm_partition info
6451 @end example
6452
6453 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6454 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6455 @example
6456 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6457 @end example
6458
6459 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6460 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6461 @example
6462 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6463 @end example
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6467 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6468 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6472 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6473 Command disables watchdog timer.
6474 @end deffn
6475 @end deffn
6476
6477 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6478 @cindex kinetis_ke
6479 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6480 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6481 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6482 autoconfigures itself.
6483 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6484
6485 @example
6486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6487 @end example
6488
6489 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6490 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6494 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6495 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6496 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6497 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6501 Command disables watchdog timer.
6502 @end deffn
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6506 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6507 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6508 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6509 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6510
6511 @quotation Note
6512 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6513 driver:
6514 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6515 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6516 @end quotation
6517
6518 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6519 which must appear in the following order:
6520
6521 @itemize
6522 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6523 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6524 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6525 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6526 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6527 LPC43x[2357])
6528 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6529 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6530 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6531 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6532 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6533 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6534 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6535 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6536 at which the core is running
6537 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6538 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6539 @quotation Note
6540 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6541 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6542 However, if you do provide it,
6543 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6544 @end quotation
6545 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6546 ROM IAP entry point.
6547 @end itemize
6548
6549 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6550
6551 @example
6552 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6553 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6554 @end example
6555
6556 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6557 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6558 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6559 @end deffn
6560 @end deffn
6561
6562 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6563 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6564 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6565 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6566 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6567 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6568
6569 @example
6570 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6571 @end example
6572 @end deffn
6573
6574 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6575 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6576 from NXP.
6577
6578 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6579 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6580 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6581 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6582 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6583 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6584 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6585 you start the PLL.
6586
6587 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6588
6589 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6590 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6591 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6592
6593 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6594 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6595 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6596 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6597 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6598 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6599 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6600
6601 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6602 @example
6603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6604 @end example
6605
6606 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6607 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6608 @code{flash banks} command.
6609
6610 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6611 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6612 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6613 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6614 a known signature.
6615 Example:
6616 @example
6617 lpc2900 signature 0
6618 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6619 @end example
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6623 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6624 saves it to a file in binary format.
6625 Example:
6626 @example
6627 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6628 @end example
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6632 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6633 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6634 command:
6635
6636 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6637 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6638 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6639 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6640
6641 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6642 Example:
6643 @example
6644 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6645 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6646 @end example
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6650 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6651 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6652 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6653 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6654 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6655 912 bytes.
6656 @quotation Attention
6657 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6658 @end quotation
6659 Example:
6660 @example
6661 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6662 @end example
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6666 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6667 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6668 after the next power cycle.
6669 @quotation Attention
6670 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6671 @end quotation
6672 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6673 Example:
6674 @example
6675 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6676 flash info 0
6677 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6678 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6679 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6680 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6681 @end example
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6685 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6686 effective after the next power cycle.
6687 @quotation Attention
6688 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6689 @end quotation
6690 Examples:
6691 @example
6692 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6693 @end example
6694 @end deffn
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6698 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6699 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6700 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6701
6702 @example
6703 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6704 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6705 @end example
6706
6707 @itemize @bullet
6708 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6709 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6710 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6711 @end itemize
6712
6713 Example usage:
6714 @example
6715 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6716 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6717 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6718 @} else @{
6719 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6720 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6721 @}
6722 @end example
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6726 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6727 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6728 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6729 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6730 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6731
6732 @example
6733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6734 @end example
6735
6736 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6737 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6738 only the main program flash.
6739
6740 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6741 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6742 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6746 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6747 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6748 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6749
6750 To erase and program the BSL:
6751 @example
6752 msp432 bsl unlock
6753 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6754 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6755 msp432 bsl lock
6756 @end example
6757 @end deffn
6758 @end deffn
6759
6760 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6761 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6762 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6763 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6764 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6765 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6766 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6767 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6768 also have division into regions: main and info.
6769 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6770 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6771
6772 @example
6773 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6774 @end example
6775
6776 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6777
6778 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6779 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6780 @end deffn
6781
6782 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6783 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6787 Erase all userflash including info region.
6788 @end deffn
6789
6790 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6791 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6795 Check sectors protect.
6796 @end deffn
6797
6798 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6799 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6800 @end deffn
6801
6802 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6803 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6804 @end deffn
6805
6806 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6807 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6811 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6812 @end deffn
6813
6814 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6815 Show information about flash driver.
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6821 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6822 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6823 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6824 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6825
6826 @example
6827 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6828 @end example
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6832 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6833 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6834 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6835 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6836
6837 @example
6838 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6839 @end example
6840
6841 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6842
6843 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6844 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6845 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6846 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6847 code.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6851 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6852 @end deffn
6853
6854 @end deffn
6855
6856 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6857 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6858 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6859
6860 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6861 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6862 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6863 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6864
6865 @example
6866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6867 @end example
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6871 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6872 and integrate flash memory.
6873
6874 @example
6875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6877 @end example
6878
6879 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6880 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6881 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6882 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6883 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6884 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6885 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6886 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6887 @end deffn
6888 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6889 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6890 This will remove any Code Protection.
6891 @end deffn
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6895 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6896 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6897 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6898 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6899
6900 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6901 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6902
6903 @example
6904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6905 @end example
6906
6907 psoc4-specific commands
6908 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6909 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6910
6911 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6912 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6913
6914 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6915 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6916 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6917
6918 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6922 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6923
6924 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6925 @end deffn
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6929 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6930 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6931 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6932 apart from the base address.
6933
6934 @example
6935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6936 @end example
6937
6938 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6939 @quotation Attention
6940 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6941 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6942 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6943 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6944 @end quotation
6945
6946 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6947
6948 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6949 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6950 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6951 @end deffn
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6955 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6956 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6957 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6958 apart from the base address.
6959
6960 @example
6961 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6962 $_TARGETNAME
6963 @end example
6964 @end deffn
6965
6966 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6967 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6968 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6969 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6970
6971 @example
6972 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6973 @end example
6974
6975 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6976
6977 @itemize
6978 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6979 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6980 @end itemize
6981
6982 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6983
6984 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6985 @quotation Attention
6986 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6987 after successful write.
6988 @end quotation
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6992 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6993 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6994 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6995
6996 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6997 @itemize @bullet
6998 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6999 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7000 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7001 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7002 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7003 row size: 512 bytes.
7004 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7005 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7006 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7007 operation will erase row automatically.
7008 @end itemize
7009
7010 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7011 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7012
7013 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7014
7015 @example
7016 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7017 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7018 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7019 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7020 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7021 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7022 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7023 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7024 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7025 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7026 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7027 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7028
7029 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7030 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7031 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7032 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7033 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7034 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7035 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7036 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7037 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7038 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7039 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7040 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7041 @end example
7042
7043 psoc6-specific commands
7044 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7045 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7046 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7047 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7048 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7049 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7050 @end deffn
7051
7052 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7053 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7054 by @command{flash banks}.
7055 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7056 @end deffn
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7060 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7061 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7062 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7063 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7064
7065 @example
7066 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7067 @end example
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7071 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7072 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7073 and SWD interface.
7074 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7075 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7076
7077 @example
7078 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7079 @end example
7080
7081 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7082
7083 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7084 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7085 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7089 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7090 @end deffn
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7094 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7095 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7096 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7097 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7098
7099 @example
7100 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7101 @end example
7102
7103 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7104 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7105 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7106 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7107 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7108 disabled.
7109
7110 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7111 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7112 @quotation Warning
7113 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7114 applied to all of them.
7115 @end quotation
7116 @end deffn
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7120 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7121 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7122 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7123 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7124 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7125
7126 @example
7127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7128 @end example
7129
7130 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7131 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7132 the flash driver.
7133
7134 @example
7135 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7136 @end example
7137
7138 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7139 as per the following example.
7140 @example
7141 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7142 @end example
7143
7144 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7145
7146 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7147 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7148 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7152 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7153 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7154 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7158 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7159 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7160 @end deffn
7161
7162 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7163 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7164 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7169 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7170 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7171 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7175 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7176 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7177 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7178 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7179 @end deffn
7180 @end deffn
7181
7182 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7183 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7184 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7185 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7186 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7187
7188 @example
7189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7190 @end example
7191
7192 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7193 as per the following example.
7194 @example
7195 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7196 @end example
7197
7198 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7199 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7200 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7204 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7205 the flash driver.
7206
7207 @example
7208 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7209 @end example
7210
7211 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7212
7213 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7214 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7215 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7219 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7220 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7221 @end deffn
7222
7223 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7224 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7225 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7229 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7230 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7231 @end deffn
7232
7233 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7234 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7235 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7236 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7237 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7238 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7242 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7243 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7244 @end deffn
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7248 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7249 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7250 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7251 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7252
7253 @example
7254 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7255 @end example
7256
7257 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7258 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7259 the flash driver.
7260
7261 @example
7262 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7263 @end example
7264
7265 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7266
7267 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7268 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7269 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7273 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7278 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7279 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7283 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7284 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7285 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7286 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7287
7288 Example usage:
7289 @example
7290 # read OPTSR_CUR
7291 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7292 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7293 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7294 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7295 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7296 @end example
7297 @end deffn
7298
7299 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7300 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7301 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7302 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7303 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7304 will be touched).
7305
7306 Example usage:
7307 @example
7308 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7309 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7310 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7311 @end example
7312 @end deffn
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7316 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7317 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7318 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7319 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7320
7321 @example
7322 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7323 @end example
7324
7325 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7326 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7327 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7328 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7329 second bank.
7330
7331 @example
7332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7333 @end example
7334
7335 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7336
7337 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7338 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7339 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7343 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7344 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7348 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7349 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7350 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7351 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7352 @end deffn
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7356 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7357 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7358 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7359 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7360 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7361
7362 @example
7363 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7364 @end example
7365
7366 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7367 as per the following example.
7368 @example
7369 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7370 @end example
7371
7372 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7373 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7374 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7375 @end deffn
7376
7377 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7378 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7379 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7380 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7381
7382 @example
7383 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7384 @end example
7385
7386 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7389 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7390 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7391
7392 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7393 @end deffn
7394
7395 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7396 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7397 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7398
7399 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7403 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7404 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7408 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7409 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7410 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7411
7412 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7413 @example
7414 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7415 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7416 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7417 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7418 @end example
7419
7420 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7421 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7425 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7426 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7427 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7428 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7429
7430 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7431
7432 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7433 @example
7434 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7435 @end example
7436
7437 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7438 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7439 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7443 List the protected areas using WRP.
7444 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7445 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7446 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7447
7448 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7449 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7450 in single or dual-banks mode.
7451 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7452 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7453
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7457 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7458 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7462 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7463 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7464 the TrustZone status.
7465 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7466 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7467 @end deffn
7468 @end deffn
7469
7470 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7471 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7472 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7473 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7474 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7475
7476 @example
7477 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7478 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7479 @end example
7480
7481 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7482 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7483 for the specified flash bank.
7484 @end deffn
7485 @end deffn
7486
7487 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7488 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7489 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7490 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7491 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7492
7493 @example
7494 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7495 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7496 @end example
7497
7498 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7499 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7500 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7501
7502 @itemize @bullet
7503 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7504 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7505 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7506 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7507 @end itemize
7508 @end deffn
7509
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7513 @cindex str9xpec
7514
7515 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7516 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7517 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7518 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7519
7520 Here is some background info to help
7521 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7522 the str9:
7523 @enumerate
7524 @item
7525 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7526 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7527 @item
7528 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7529 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7530 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7531 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7532 @end enumerate
7533
7534 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7535 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7536 configured for flash bank 0.
7537 @example
7538 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7539 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7540 adapter assert srst
7541 # turn off target polling
7542 poll off
7543 # disable str9 core
7544 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7545 # read option bytes
7546 str9xpec options_read 0
7547 # re-enable str9 core
7548 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7549 poll on
7550 reset halt
7551 @end example
7552 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7553 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7554 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7555 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7556
7557 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7558
7559 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7560 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7561 @end deffn
7562
7563 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7564 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7565 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7566 @end deffn
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7569 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7570 erase the device.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7574 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7578 Configure str9 boot bank.
7579 @end deffn
7580
7581 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7582 Configure str9 lvd source.
7583 @end deffn
7584
7585 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7586 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7590 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7594 Read str9 option bytes.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7598 Write str9 option bytes.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7602 unlock str9 device.
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7608 @cindex swm050
7609 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7610
7611 @example
7612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7613 @end example
7614
7615 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7616
7617 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7618 Erases the entire flash bank.
7619 @end deffn
7620
7621 @end deffn
7622
7623
7624 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7625 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7626 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7627 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7628
7629 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7630
7631 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7632 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7633 @end deffn
7634
7635 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7636 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7640 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7641 the flash clock.
7642 @end deffn
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7646 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7647 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7648 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7649 correct bank config.
7650
7651 @example
7652 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7653 @end example
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7657 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7658 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7659 @end deffn
7660
7661 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7662 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7663 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7664
7665 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7666
7667 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7668 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7672 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @end deffn
7676
7677 @section NAND Flash Commands
7678 @cindex NAND
7679
7680 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7681 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7682 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7683
7684 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7685 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7686 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7687 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7688 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7689 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7690
7691 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7692 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7693 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7694 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7695 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7696 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7697 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7698 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7699 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7700 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7701
7702 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7703 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7704 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7705 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7706 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7707 every 512 bytes of data.
7708
7709 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7710 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7711 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7712 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7713 ECC mode is used.
7714
7715 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7716 @enumerate
7717 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7718 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7719 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7720 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7721 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7722 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7723 to access that device.
7724 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7725 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7726 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7727 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7728 de-brick a board.
7729 @end enumerate
7730
7731 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7732 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7733 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7734 are only 32 bits wide.
7735 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7736 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7737 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7738 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7739
7740 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7741 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7742 @cindex NAND configuration
7743
7744 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7745 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7746 OpenOCD has initialized.
7747
7748 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7749 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7750 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7751 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7752 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7753 they were a single (larger) device.
7754 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7755 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7756
7757 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7758 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7759 configuration files, not interactively.
7760
7761 @itemize @bullet
7762 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7763 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7764 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7765 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7766 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7767 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7768 commands to the NAND controller.
7769 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7770 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7771 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7772 for more information.
7773 @end itemize
7774 @end deffn
7775
7776 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7777 Prints a summary of each device declared
7778 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7779 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7780 @example
7781 > nand list
7782 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7783 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7784 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7785 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7786 >
7787 @end example
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7791 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7792 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7793 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7794 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7795 it with most other NAND commands.
7796 @end deffn
7797
7798 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7799
7800 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7801 @cindex NAND reading
7802 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7803 starting at the specified offset.
7804 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7805
7806 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7807 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7808
7809 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7810 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7811 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7812
7813 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7814 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7815 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7816 method which handled that error correction.
7817
7818 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7819 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7820 @itemize @bullet
7821 @item no oob_* parameter
7822 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7823 @item @code{oob_raw}
7824 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7825 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7826 spare areas associated with each data page.
7827 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7828 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7829 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7830 @item @code{oob_only}
7831 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7832 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7833 spare areas associated with each data page.
7834 @end itemize
7835 @end deffn
7836
7837 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7838 @cindex NAND erasing
7839 @cindex NAND programming
7840 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7841 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7842 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7843 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7844 If those parameters are not specified,
7845 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7846 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7847
7848 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7849 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7850 block marker.
7851 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7852 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7853 @end deffn
7854
7855 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7856 @cindex NAND writing
7857 @cindex NAND programming
7858 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7859 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7860 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7861 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7862
7863 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7864 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7865
7866 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7867 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7868 past the end of the device.
7869 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7870 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7871 if that's being written.)
7872
7873 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7874 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7875 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7876
7877 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7878 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7879 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7880 @itemize @bullet
7881 @item no oob_* parameter
7882 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7883 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7884 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7885 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7886 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7887 @item @code{oob_only}
7888 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7889 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7890 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7891 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7892 @item @code{oob_raw}
7893 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7894 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7895 un-altered OOB.
7896 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7897 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7898 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7899 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7900 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7901 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7902 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7903 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7904 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7905 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7906 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7907 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7908 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7909 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7910 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7911 @end itemize
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7915 @cindex NAND verification
7916 @cindex NAND programming
7917 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7918 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7919 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7920
7921 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7922 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7923
7924 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7925 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7926 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7927 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7928 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7929
7930 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7931 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7932 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7933
7934 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7935 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7936 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7937 be removed in a future release.
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @subsection Other NAND commands
7941 @cindex NAND other commands
7942
7943 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7944 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7945 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7946 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7947 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7948 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7949 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7950 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7951
7952 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7953 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7954 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7958 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7959 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7960 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7961 status for each block.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7965 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7966 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7967
7968 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7969 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7970 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7971 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7972 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7973
7974 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7975 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7976 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7977 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7978 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7979 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7980 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7984 @subsection NAND Driver List
7985 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7986 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7987 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7988
7989 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7990 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7991 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7992 address of the ECC controller.
7993 @example
7994 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7995 @end example
7996 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7997 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7998 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7999 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8000 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8001 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8002 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8003 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8004 @end deffn
8005 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8006 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8007 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8008 @end deffn
8009
8010 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8011 properly configured for input or output.
8012 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8013 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8014 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8015 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8016 @end deffn
8017 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8018 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8019 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8020 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8021 @end deffn
8022 @end deffn
8023
8024 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8025 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8026 chips from Texas Instruments.
8027 It takes three extra parameters:
8028 address of the NAND chip;
8029 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8030 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8031 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8032 @example
8033 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8034 @end example
8035 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8036 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8037 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8038 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8039 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8043 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8044 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8045 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8046 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8047 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8048 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8052 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8053 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8054 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8055 @end deffn
8056 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8057
8058 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8059 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8060 should work for this chip as well.
8061 @end deffn
8062
8063 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8064 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8065 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8066 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8067 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8068 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8069 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8070 @example
8071 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8072 @end example
8073 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8074 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8075 without parameter query status.
8076 @end deffn
8077 @end deffn
8078
8079 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8080 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8081 parameter: the address of the controller.
8082 @example
8083 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8084 @end example
8085 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8086 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8087 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8088 change any behavior.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8092 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8093 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8094 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8095 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8096 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8097 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8098 specialized commands.
8099 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8100 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8101 change any behavior.
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @node Flash Programming
8105 @chapter Flash Programming
8106
8107 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8108 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8109 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8110
8111 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8112 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8113
8114 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8115 @enumerate
8116 @item 'init' is executed.
8117 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8118 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8119 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8120 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8121 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8122 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8123 @end enumerate
8124
8125 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8126
8127 @example
8128 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8129 # are optional parameters
8130 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8131 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8132
8133 # binary files need the flash address passing
8134 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8135 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8136 @end example
8137
8138 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8139 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8140 @cindex PLD
8141 @cindex FPGA
8142
8143 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8144 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8145 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8146 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8147 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8148 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8149 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8150
8151 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8152
8153 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8154 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8155 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8156
8157 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8158 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8159
8160 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8161 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8162 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8163 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8164 behavior.
8165 @end deffn
8166
8167 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8168 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8172 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8173 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8174 @end deffn
8175
8176 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8177
8178 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8179 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8180 that particular type of PLD.
8181
8182 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8183 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8184 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8185
8186 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8187 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8188 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8189
8190 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8191 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8192 for FPGA @var{num}.
8193 @end deffn
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @node General Commands
8197 @chapter General Commands
8198 @cindex commands
8199
8200 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8201 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8202 commands are documented elsewhere.
8203
8204 Intent:
8205 @itemize @bullet
8206 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8207 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8208 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8209 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8210
8211 @item @b{From the human}
8212 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8213 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8214
8215 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8216 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8217 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8218
8219 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8220 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8221 port is 5555.
8222 @end itemize
8223
8224
8225 @section Server Commands
8226
8227 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8228 Exits the current telnet session.
8229 @end deffn
8230
8231 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8232 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8233 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8234 Not every command provides helptext.
8235
8236 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8237 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8238 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8239 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8243 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8244 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8245 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8246 Useful in connection with script files
8247 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8251 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8252 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8253 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8254
8255 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8256 @example
8257 # redefine shutdown
8258 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8259 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8260 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8261 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8262 original_shutdown
8263 @}
8264 @end example
8265 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8266 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @anchor{debuglevel}
8270 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8271 @cindex message level
8272 Display debug level.
8273 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8274 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8275 Level 0 is error messages only;
8276 level 1 adds warnings;
8277 level 2 adds informational messages;
8278 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8279 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8280 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8281 the command line along with the location of that log
8282 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8283 @xref{Running}.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8287 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8288 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8289 @example
8290 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8291 @end example
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8295 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8296 the default log output channel is stderr.
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8300 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8301 @end deffn
8302
8303 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8304 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8305 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8306 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8307 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8311 @section Target State handling
8312 @cindex reset
8313 @cindex halt
8314 @cindex target initialization
8315
8316 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8317 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8318 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8319 a current target which is used to perform the
8320 various operations. The current target may be changed
8321 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8322 target which should become current.
8323
8324 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8325 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8326 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8327 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8328 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8329
8330 @emph{With no arguments}:
8331 list all available registers for the current target,
8332 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8333 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8334 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8335 are flagged as such.
8336
8337 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8338 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8339 bypassing any internal cache.
8340
8341 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8342 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8343 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8344 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8345 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8346 relevant module will flush such values.
8347
8348 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8349 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8350
8351 @example
8352 > reg
8353 ===== ARM registers
8354 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8355 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8356 (2) r2 (/32)
8357 ...
8358 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8359 >
8360 @end example
8361 @end deffn
8362
8363 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8364 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8365 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8366 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8367 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8368 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8369 (and enter debug mode).
8370 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8371
8372 @quotation Warning
8373 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8374 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8375 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8376 power mode by gating the core clock;
8377 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8378
8379 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8380 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8381 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8382 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8383 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8384 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8385
8386 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8387 work with a JTAG debugger.
8388 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8389 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8390 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8391 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8392 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8393 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8394 @end quotation
8395
8396 @end deffn
8397
8398 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8399 Resume the target at its current code position,
8400 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8401 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8405 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8406 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @anchor{resetcommand}
8410 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8411 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8412 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8413 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8414 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8415 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8416 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8417
8418 The optional parameter specifies what should
8419 happen after the reset.
8420 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8421 The other options will not work on all systems.
8422 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8423
8424 @itemize @minus
8425 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8426 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8427 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8428 @end itemize
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8432 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8433 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8434 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8435 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8436 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8437 state.
8438 @end deffn
8439
8440 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8441 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8442 Set values of reset signals.
8443 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8444 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8445 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8446 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8447
8448 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8449 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8450 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8451 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8452 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8453 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8454 the signal will not be modified.
8455
8456 @quotation Note
8457 TRST is specially handled.
8458 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8459 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8460 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8461 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8462 instead of the TRST signal.
8463 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8464 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8465 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8466 with handlers for that event.
8467 @end quotation
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8471 @section Memory access commands
8472 @cindex memory access
8473
8474 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8475 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8476 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8477 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8478
8479 @enumerate
8480 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8481 to change the current target.
8482 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8483 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8484 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8485 @end enumerate
8486
8487 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8488 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8489 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8490 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8491 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8492 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8493 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8494 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8495 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8496 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8497 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8498 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8499 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8500 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8501 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8502 @end deffn
8503
8504 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8505 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8506 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8507 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8508 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8509 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8510 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8511 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8512 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8513 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8514 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8515 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8516 @end deffn
8517
8518 @anchor{imageaccess}
8519 @section Image loading commands
8520 @cindex image loading
8521 @cindex image dumping
8522
8523 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8524 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8525 binary file named @var{filename}.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8529 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8530 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8534 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8535 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8536 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8537 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8538 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8539 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8540 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8541 separately.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8545 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8546 The file format may optionally be specified
8547 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8548 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8549 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8550 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8551 @example
8552 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8553 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8554 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8555 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8556 $address $length
8557 @}
8558 @end example
8559 @end deffn
8560
8561 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8562 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8563 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8564 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8565 The file format may optionally be specified
8566 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8570 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8571 The file format may optionally be specified
8572 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8573 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8574 @end deffn
8575
8576 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8577 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8578 The file format may optionally be specified
8579 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8580 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583
8584 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8585 @cindex breakpoint
8586 @cindex watchpoint
8587
8588 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8589 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8590 watchpoints.
8591 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8592
8593 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8594 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8595 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8596 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8597 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8598 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8599
8600 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8601 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8605 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8609 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8613 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8614 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8615 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8616 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8617 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8618 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8619 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8620 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623
8624 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8625
8626 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8627 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8628 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8629 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8630 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8631 running, can be used.
8632 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8633 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8634 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8635
8636 @quotation Note
8637 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8638 @end quotation
8639
8640 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8641 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8642 communication, respectively.
8643
8644 @quotation Note
8645 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8646 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8647 example.
8648 @end quotation
8649
8650 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8651 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8652 of TCP/IP connections.
8653
8654 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8655 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8656 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8657 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8658 @var{size} bytes.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8662 Start RTT.
8663 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8667 Stop RTT.
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8671 Display the polling interval.
8672 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8673 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8674 checked for new data.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8678 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8682 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8683 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8687 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8688 @end deffn
8689
8690 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8691 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8695 on the target device.
8696
8697 @example
8698 resume
8699
8700 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8701 rtt start
8702
8703 rtt server start 9090 0
8704 @end example
8705
8706 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8707 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8708 TCP/IP port 9090.
8709
8710
8711 @section Misc Commands
8712
8713 @cindex profiling
8714 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8715 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8716 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8717 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8718 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8719 limit the address range.
8720 @end deffn
8721
8722 @deffn {Command} {version}
8723 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8724 @end deffn
8725
8726 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8727 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8728 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8732 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8733 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8734 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8735
8736 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8737 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8738 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8739 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8740
8741 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8742 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8743 @cindex tracing
8744 @cindex ETM
8745 @cindex ETB
8746
8747 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8748 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8749 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8750
8751 @itemize
8752 @item
8753 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8754 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8755 supports such an interface.
8756 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8757 and trace port support.)
8758 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8759 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8760 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8761 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8762 in the board-specific configuration file.
8763 @item
8764 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8765 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8766 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8767 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8768 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8769 @end itemize
8770
8771 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8772
8773 @quotation Issues
8774 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8775 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8776
8777 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8778 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8779 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8780 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8781 dummy trace port driver}.
8782
8783 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8784 as well as tracing only during specific states
8785 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8786
8787 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8788 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8789 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8790 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8791 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8792
8793 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8794 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8795 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8796 this original style of JTAG access.
8797 @end quotation
8798
8799 @subsection ETM Configuration
8800 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8801
8802 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8803 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8804 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8805
8806 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8807 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8808 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8809 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8810 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8811 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8812 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8813 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8814 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8815
8816 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8817 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8818 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8819
8820 @quotation Warning
8821 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8822 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8823 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8824 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8825 @end quotation
8826
8827 @quotation Note
8828 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8829 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8830 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8831 what CPU activities are traced.
8832 @end quotation
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8836 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8837 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8838 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8839 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8840 @end deffn
8841
8842 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8843 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8844 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8845 Did trace data overflow?
8846 Was it triggered?
8847 @end deffn
8848
8849 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8850 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8851 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8852 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8853 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8854
8855 @itemize
8856 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8857 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8858 The value is one of
8859 @option{none} (save nothing),
8860 @option{data} (save data),
8861 @option{address} (save addresses),
8862 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8863 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8864 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8865 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8866 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8867 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8868 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8869 trace stream without an image of the code.
8870 @end itemize
8871 @end deffn
8872
8873 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8874 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8875 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8876 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8877 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8878
8879 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8880 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8881 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8882 @end deffn
8883
8884 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8885
8886 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8887 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8888 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8889
8890 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8891 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8892 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8893 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8894 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8895 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8896 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8897
8898 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8899
8900 @itemize
8901 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8902 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8903 for instruction access within that function's body.
8904 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8905 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8906 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8907 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8908 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8909 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8910 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8911 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8912 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8913 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8914 @item @emph{... more}
8915 @end itemize
8916
8917 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8918 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8919
8920 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8921 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8922 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8923 @end deffn
8924
8925 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8926 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8927 @end deffn
8928
8929 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8930 Opens an image file.
8931 @end deffn
8932
8933 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8934 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8935 @end deffn
8936
8937 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8938 Starts trace data collection.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8942 Stops trace data collection.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8946 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8947
8948 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8949
8950 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8951 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8952 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8953 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8954 any trace data collection.}
8955 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8956 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8957 @end deffn
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8961 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8962 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8963 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8964 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8965 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8966 @end deffn
8967 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8968 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8969 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8970 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8971 trace trigger becomes active.
8972
8973 @itemize
8974 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8975 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8976 afterwards.
8977 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8978 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8979 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8980 what caused that event to happen.
8981 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8982 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8983 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8984 how the event caused trouble.
8985 @end itemize
8986 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8987 @end deffn
8988
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8992 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8993 @cindex CTI
8994
8995 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8996 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8997 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8998 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8999 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9000 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9001
9002 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9003 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9004 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9005 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9006 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9007 including additional configuration.
9008 @end deffn
9009
9010 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9011 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9015 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9019 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9023 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9027 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9031 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9032 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9036 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9037 of the CTI.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9041 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9042 useful in TCL scripting.
9043 @end deffn
9044
9045 @section Generic ARM
9046 @cindex ARM
9047
9048 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9049 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9050 commands that may be available.
9051
9052 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9053 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9054 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9055 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9056 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9057 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9061 @cindex disassemble
9062 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9063 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9064 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9065 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9066 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9067 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9068 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9069
9070 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9071 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9072 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9073 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9074 with a handful of exceptions.
9075 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9079 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9080 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9081 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9082 and using the MCR instruction.
9083 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9084 an ARM register.)
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9088 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9089 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9090 and the MRC instruction.
9091 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9092 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9093 an ARM register.)
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9097 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9098 core mode if necessary.
9099 @end deffn
9100
9101 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9102 @cindex ARM semihosting
9103 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9104
9105 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9106 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9107 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9108 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9109 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9110 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9111 @end deffn
9112
9113 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9114 @cindex ARM semihosting
9115 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9116
9117 @example
9118 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9119 @end example
9120
9121 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9122 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9123 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9124 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9125 @end deffn
9126
9127 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9128 @cindex ARM semihosting
9129 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9130 status.
9131
9132 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9133 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9134 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9135 debugger.
9136 @end deffn
9137
9138 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9139 @cindex ARM semihosting
9140 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9141
9142 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9143 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9144 the value returned by the target.
9145
9146 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9147 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9148 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9149 encountering a break.
9150
9151 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9152 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9153 to the debugger.
9154 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9155 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9156 request or equivalent").
9157
9158 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9159 this option (default: disabled).
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9163 @cindex ARMv4
9164 @cindex ARMv5
9165
9166 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9167 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9168 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9169 variant.
9170
9171 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9172 @cindex ARM7
9173 @cindex ARM9
9174
9175 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9176 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9177 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9178 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9179
9180 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9181 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9182 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9183 instead of breakpoints.
9184 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9185
9186 This should be
9187 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9188 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9189 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9193 @cindex DCC
9194 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9195 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9196 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9197
9198 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9199 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9200 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9204 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9205 that don't check completion of the operation.
9206 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9207
9208 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9209 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9210 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9211 @end deffn
9212
9213 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9214 @cindex ARM9
9215
9216 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9217 integer processors.
9218 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9219
9220 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9221 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9222 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9223 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9224
9225 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9226 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9227 @cindex vector_catch
9228 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9229 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9230 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9231 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9232 to those hardware vectors.
9233
9234 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9235 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9236 vector catch hardware to intercept
9237 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9238 @option{none} of them,
9239 or a list with one or more of the following:
9240 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9241 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9242 @end deffn
9243
9244 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9245 @cindex ARM920T
9246
9247 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9248 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9249 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9250 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9251 and ARM9 commands.
9252
9253 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9254 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9255 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9256 @end deffn
9257
9258 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9259 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9260 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9261 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9262 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9263 (Not all registers can be written.)
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9267 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9268 @end deffn
9269
9270 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9271 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9275 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9276
9277 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9278 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9279 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9280 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9281 and ARM9 commands.
9282
9283 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9284 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9285
9286 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9287 Print information about the caches found.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9291 @cindex ARM966E
9292
9293 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9294 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9295 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9296 and ARM9 commands.
9297
9298 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9299 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9300 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9301 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9302 ARM966E-S TRM.
9303 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9304 as required for BIST support.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @subsection XScale specific commands
9308 @cindex XScale
9309
9310 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9311
9312 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9313 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9314 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9315 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9316 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9317 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9318 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9319
9320 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9321 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9322 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9323 the mini-IC.
9324
9325 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9326 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9327 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9328 code layout in memory:
9329 @example
9330 _vectors:
9331 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9332 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9333 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9334 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9335 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9336 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9337 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9338 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9339 .org 0x100
9340 .long real_reset_vector
9341 .long real_ui_handler
9342 .long real_swi_handler
9343 .long real_pf_abort
9344 .long real_data_abort
9345 .long 0 /* unused */
9346 .long real_irq_handler
9347 .long real_fiq_handler
9348 @end example
9349
9350 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9351 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9352 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9353 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9354 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9355 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9356 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9357 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9358 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9359 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9360 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9361 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9362 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9363 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9364 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9365 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9366 software.
9367
9368 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9369 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9370 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9371 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9372
9373 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9374 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9375 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9376 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9377 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9378 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9379 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9380 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9381 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9382
9383 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9384 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9385
9386 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9387 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9391 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9395 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9399 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9400 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9404 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9405 @end deffn
9406
9407 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9408 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9412 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9416 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9420 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9424 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9425 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9426 and modifying how it is emptied.
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9430 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9431 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9432 The image @var{type} may be one of
9433 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9434 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9435 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9439 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9440 @cindex vector_catch
9441 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9442 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9443
9444 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9445 @example
9446 0x01 Trap Reset
9447 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9448 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9449 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9450 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9451 0x20 reserved
9452 0x40 Trap IRQ
9453 0x80 Trap FIQ
9454 @end example
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9458 @cindex vector_table
9459
9460 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9461 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9462 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9463 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9464 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9465
9466 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9467
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9471 @cindex ARMv6
9472
9473 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9474 @cindex ARM11
9475
9476 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9477 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9478 which is enabled by default.
9479 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9480 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9481 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9482 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9483 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9484 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9485 @end deffn
9486
9487 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9488 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9489 which is enabled by default.
9490 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9491 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9495 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9496 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9497 they are disabled by default.
9498 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9502 @cindex vector_catch
9503 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9504 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9505 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9506
9507 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9508 for certain hardware events.
9509 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9510 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9511 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9515 @cindex ARMv7
9516 @cindex ARMv8
9517
9518 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9519 @cindex Cortex-A
9520
9521 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9522 display information about target caches
9523 @end deffn
9524
9525 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9526 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9527 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9528 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9529 Defaults to 'off'.
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9533 Initialize core debug
9534 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9535 @end deffn
9536
9537 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9538 Display/set the current SMP mode
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9542 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9546 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9550 configure l2x cache
9551 @end deffn
9552
9553 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9554 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9555 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9556 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9557 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9561 @cindex Cortex-R
9562
9563 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9564 Initialize core debug
9565 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9566 @end deffn
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9569 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572
9573 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9574 @cindex tracing
9575 @cindex SWO
9576 @cindex SWV
9577 @cindex TPIU
9578
9579 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9580 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9581 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9582 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9583
9584 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9585 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9586 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9587 which causes quite some confusion.
9588 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9589 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9590
9591 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9592 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9593 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9594
9595 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9596 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9597 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9598 @end deffn
9599
9600 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9601 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9602 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9603 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9604
9605 @itemize @bullet
9606 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9607 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9608 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9609 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9610
9611 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9612 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9613 @end itemize
9614 @end deffn
9615
9616 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9617 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9618 @end deffn
9619
9620 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9621 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9622 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9623 at any time after the initialization, too.
9624 @end deffn
9625
9626 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9627 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9628 individually queried, to return its current value.
9629 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9633 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9634 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9635 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9636
9637 @itemize @bullet
9638 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9639 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9640
9641 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9642 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9643
9644 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9645 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9646
9647 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9648 protocol used for trace data:
9649 @itemize @minus
9650 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9651 data bits (default);
9652 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9653 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9654 @end itemize
9655
9656 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9657 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9658 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9659 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9660 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9661 of the TPIU.
9662
9663 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9664 the destination of the trace data:
9665 @itemize @minus
9666 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9667 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9668 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9669 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9670 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9671 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9672 each connected client;
9673 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9674 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9675 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9676 @end itemize
9677
9678 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9679 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9680 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9681 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9682
9683 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9684 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9685 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9686 maximum supported rate automatically.
9687
9688 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9689 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9690 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9691
9692 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9693 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9694 default value is @var{0}.
9695 @end itemize
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9699 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9700 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9701 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9702 data.
9703 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9704 after the @command{init}.
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9708 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9709 @end deffn
9710
9711
9712
9713 Example usage:
9714 @enumerate
9715 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9716 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9717 enough to:
9718 @example
9719 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9720 ...
9721 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9722 ...
9723 @end example
9724 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9725 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9726 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9727 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9728 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9729 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9730 @example
9731 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9732 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9733 @end example
9734 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9735 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9736 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9737 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9738 @example
9739 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9740 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9741 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9742 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9743 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9744 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9745 @end example
9746 @end enumerate
9747
9748 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9749 @cindex tracing
9750 @cindex SWO
9751 @cindex SWV
9752 @cindex ITM
9753 @cindex ETM
9754
9755 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9756 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9757 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9761 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9762 @end deffn
9763
9764 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9765 @cindex Cortex-M
9766
9767 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9768 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9769
9770 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9771 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9772 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9773 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9774 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9775 the step command leaves with the core running.
9776
9777 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9778 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9779 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9780 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9781
9782 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9783 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9784 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9785 does.
9786
9787 Default is @option{auto}.
9788 @end deffn
9789
9790 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9791 @cindex vector_catch
9792 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9793 for certain hardware events.
9794
9795 Parameters request interception of
9796 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9797 @option{none} of them,
9798 or one or more of the following:
9799 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9800 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9801 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9802 @option{irq_err},
9803 @option{state_err},
9804 @option{chk_err}, or
9805 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9806 @option{reset}.
9807 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9808 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9809 are mapped to HardFault.
9810 UsageFault checks for
9811 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9812 must also be explicitly enabled.
9813
9814 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9818 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9819 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9820
9821 @itemize @minus
9822 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9823 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9824 @end itemize
9825
9826 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9827 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9828 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9829 to manually reset the peripherals.
9830 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9831
9832 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9833 instead.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9837 @cindex ARMv8-A
9838 @cindex aarch64
9839
9840 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9841 Display information about target caches
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9845 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9846 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9847 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9848 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9849 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9853 @cindex disassemble
9854 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9855 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9856 @end deffn
9857
9858 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9859 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9860 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9861 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9862 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9866 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9867 @option{on}.
9868 @end deffn
9869
9870 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9871 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9872 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9873 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9874 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9875 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9876 @end deffn
9877
9878 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9879
9880 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9881 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9882
9883 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9884
9885 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9886 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9887 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9891 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9892 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9893 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9894 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9898
9899 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9900 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9901 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9905
9906 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9907 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9908 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9909 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9910 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9911 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9912 can be collected.
9913
9914 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9915 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9916 tooling.
9917
9918 @quotation Issues
9919 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9920 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9921 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9922 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9923
9924 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9925 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9926 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9927 software operation on the CPU.
9928 @end quotation
9929
9930 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9931 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9932 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9933 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9934 @end deffn
9935
9936 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9937 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9938 @end deffn
9939
9940 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9941 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9942 control is disabled.
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9946 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9947 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9948 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9949
9950 Supported trace formats:
9951 @itemize
9952 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9953 timing to be determined.
9954 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9955 addresses.
9956 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9957 @end itemize
9958 @end deffn
9959
9960 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9961 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9962 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9963 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9964
9965 Supported conditions:
9966 @itemize
9967 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9968 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9969 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9970 instruction matches start data and mask.
9971 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9972 instruction matches start data and mask.
9973 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9974 data and mask.
9975 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9976 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9977 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9978 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9979 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9980 @end itemize
9981 @end deffn
9982
9983 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9984 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9985 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9986 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9987
9988 Supported conditions:
9989 @itemize
9990 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9991 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9992 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9993 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9994 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9995 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9996 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9997 data and mask.
9998 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9999 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10000 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10001 @end itemize
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10005 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10006
10007 Supported triggers:
10008 @itemize
10009 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10010 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10011 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10012 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10013 collection.
10014 @end itemize
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10018
10019 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10020 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10021 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10022 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10023 @end deffn
10024
10025 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10026 Display trace configuration.
10027 @end deffn
10028
10029 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10030 Display trace collection status.
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10034 Start manual trace collection.
10035 @end deffn
10036
10037 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10038 Stop manual trace collection.
10039 @end deffn
10040
10041 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10042 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10043 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10044 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10045 @option{size} options using DMA.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10049 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10050 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10051 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10052 @option{size} options using DMA.
10053 @end deffn
10054
10055 @section Intel Architecture
10056
10057 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10058 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10059 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10060 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10061 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10062 @itemize
10063 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10064 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10065 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10066 @end itemize
10067
10068 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10069 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10070 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10071
10072 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10073 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10074 @end deffn
10075
10076 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10077 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10078 @end deffn
10079
10080 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10081 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10085 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10086 @end deffn
10087
10088 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10089 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10093 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10097
10098 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10099 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10100
10101 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10102 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10103 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10104 @end deffn
10105 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10106 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10107
10108 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10109
10110 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10111 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10112 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10113 @end deffn
10114
10115 @subsection Registers commands
10116 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10117 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10118 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10119
10120 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10121
10122 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10123 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10124 and "timer" groups.
10125
10126 @emph{example:}
10127 @example
10128 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10129 @end example
10130
10131 @end deffn
10132
10133 @section RISC-V Architecture
10134
10135 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10136 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10137 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10138 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10139 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10140 implement version 0.11.
10141
10142 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10143
10144 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10145 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10146 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10147
10148 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10149
10150 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10151 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10152 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10153
10154 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10155 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10156 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10157 CSRs.
10158 @end deffn
10159
10160 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10161 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10162 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10163 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10164 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10165 This command must be executed before `init`.
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10169 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10170 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10171 @end deffn
10172
10173 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10174 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10175 deasserted.
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10179 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10180 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10181 @end deffn
10182
10183 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10184 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10185 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10186 on physical memory.
10187 @end deffn
10188
10189 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10190 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10191 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10192 performed on physical memory.
10193 @end deffn
10194
10195 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10196 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10197 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10198 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10199 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10200 race condition problem in your code.
10201
10202 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10203 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10204 @end deffn
10205
10206 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10207 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10208 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10209 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10210 values.
10211
10212 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10213 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10214 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10218 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10219 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10220 @end deffn
10221
10222 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10223 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10224 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10228 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10229 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10233 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10234 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10235 @end deffn
10236
10237 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10238
10239 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10240 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10241 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10242 @example
10243 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10244 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10245 @end example
10246
10247 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10248 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10252 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10253 @end deffn
10254
10255 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10256
10257 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10258 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10261 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10262 @end deffn
10263
10264 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10265 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10266 @end deffn
10267
10268 @section ARC Architecture
10269 @cindex ARC
10270
10271 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10272 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10273 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10274 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10275 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10276 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10277 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10278 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10279 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10280 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10281 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10282 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10283 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10284 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10285 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10286
10287
10288 @subsection General ARC commands
10289
10290 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10291
10292 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10293 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10294 arguments:
10295
10296 @itemize @bullet
10297
10298 @item @code{-name} name
10299 @*Name of a register.
10300
10301 @item @code{-num} number
10302 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10303
10304 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10305 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10306
10307 @end itemize
10308
10309 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10310
10311 @itemize @bullet
10312
10313 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10314 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10315 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10316 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10317 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10318 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10319
10320 @item @code{-core}
10321 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10322 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10323 spaces.
10324
10325 @item @code{-bcr}
10326 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10327 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10328 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10329 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10330 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10331
10332 @item @code{-type} type_name
10333 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10334 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10335
10336 @item @code{-g}
10337 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10338 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10339 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10340 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10341 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10342
10343 @end itemize
10344
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10348 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10349 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10350 @end deffn
10351
10352 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10353 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10354 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10355 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10356 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10357 startbit endbit}.
10358 @end deffn
10359
10360 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10361 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10362 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10366 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10367 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10368 @end deffn
10369
10370 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10371
10372 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10373 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10374 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10375 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10376
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10380 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10381 registers.
10382 @end deffn
10383
10384 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10385 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10386 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10387 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10388
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10392 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10393 registers.
10394 @end deffn
10395
10396 @section STM8 Architecture
10397 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10398 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10399
10400 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10401 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10402
10403 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10404 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10405 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10406 @cindex tracing
10407 @cindex libdcc
10408 @cindex DCC
10409 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10410 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10411 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10412 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10413
10414 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10415 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10416 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10417 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10418 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10419 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10420
10421 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10422 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10423 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10424 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10425 The target being debugged may
10426 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10427 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10428 each supported by a command:
10429
10430 @itemize
10431 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10432 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10433 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10434 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10435
10436 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10437 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10438 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10439
10440 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10441 and then displayed at any time.
10442 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10443
10444 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10445 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10446 @end itemize
10447
10448 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10449 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10450 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10451 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10452 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10453 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10454 does the same thing.
10455
10456 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10457 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10458 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10459 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10460 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10461
10462 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10463 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10464 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10465 @end deffn
10466
10467 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10468 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10469 in the order they triggered.
10470 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10471 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10472 history records.
10473 @end deffn
10474
10475 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10476 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10477 they have been triggered.
10478 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10479 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10480 and associates it with that identifier.
10481
10482 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10483 are not related except by this command.
10484 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10485 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10486 @end deffn
10487
10488
10489 @node JTAG Commands
10490 @chapter JTAG Commands
10491 @cindex JTAG Commands
10492 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10493 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10494 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10495 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10496 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10497
10498 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10499 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10500
10501 @itemize @bullet
10502 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10503 devices such as a CPUs.
10504 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10505 standard state machine (in parallel)
10506 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10507 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10508 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10509 while the reading previous ones.
10510 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10511 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10512 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10513 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10514 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10515 registers.
10516 @end itemize
10517
10518 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10519
10520 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10521 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10522 the order of TAP state transitions.
10523 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10524 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10525 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10526 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10527 these commands are not available.
10528
10529 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10530 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10531 that specify the entire register.
10532 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10533 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10534 The return value holds the original value of each
10535 of those fields.
10536
10537 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10538 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10539 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10540 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10541 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10542
10543 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10544 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10545
10546 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10547 in that state.
10548 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10549 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10550 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10551
10552 @quotation Warning
10553 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10554 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10555 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10556 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10557 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10558 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10559 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10560 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10561 @end quotation
10562 @end deffn
10563
10564 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10565 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10566 This may be used for performance tuning.
10567
10568 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10569 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10570 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10571 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10572 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10573 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10574 @end deffn
10575
10576 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10577 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10578 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10579 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10580 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10581 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10582
10583 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10584 in that state.
10585 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10586 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10587 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10588
10589 @quotation Note
10590 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10591 register values, unlike data register values.
10592 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10593 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10594 @end quotation
10595 @end deffn
10596
10597 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10598 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10599 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10600 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10601 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10602 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10603 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10604 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10605 The final state must also be stable.
10606 @end deffn
10607
10608 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10609 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10610 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10611 Instructions often need some time
10612 to execute before they take effect.
10613 @end deffn
10614
10615 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10616 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10617
10618 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10619 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10620 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10621 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10622 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10623 @end deffn
10624
10625 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10626 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10627 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10628 must also be enabled.
10629 Default is enabled.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @section TAP state names
10633 @cindex TAP state names
10634
10635 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10636 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10637 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10638 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10639
10640 @itemize @bullet
10641 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10642 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10643 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10644 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10645 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10646 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10647 through the data register
10648 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10649 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10650 for update or more shifting
10651 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10652 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10653 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10654 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10655 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10656 through the instruction register
10657 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10658 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10659 for update or more shifting
10660 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10661 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10662 @end itemize
10663
10664 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10665 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10666 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10667 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10668
10669 @itemize @bullet
10670 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10671 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10672 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10673 may not be as expected.
10674 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10675 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10676 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10677 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10678 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10679 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10680 @end itemize
10681
10682 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10683 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10684
10685 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10686 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10687 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10688 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10689
10690 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10691 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10692 @cindex SVF
10693
10694 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10695 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10696 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10697 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10698
10699 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10700 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10701 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10702 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10703
10704 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10705 affect their semantics.
10706
10707 Command options:
10708 @itemize @minus
10709 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10710 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10711 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10712 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10713 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10714 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10715 on the real interface;
10716 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10717 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10718 errors.
10719 @end itemize
10720 @end deffn
10721
10722 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10723 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10724 @cindex XSVF
10725
10726 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10727 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10728 Xilinx devices.
10729 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10730 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10731
10732 @quotation Important
10733 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10734 @end quotation
10735
10736 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10737 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10738 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10739 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10740 that TAP.
10741 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10742 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10743 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10744 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10745 @end deffn
10746
10747 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10748 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10749 after building the software.
10750 You may find them useful:
10751
10752 @itemize
10753 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10754 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10755 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10756 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10757 @end itemize
10758
10759 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10760 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10761 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10762 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10763 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10764 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10765 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10766
10767
10768 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10769 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10770 @cindex IPDBG
10771
10772 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10773 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10774 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10775 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10776 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10777 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10778
10779 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10780 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10781
10782 Command options:
10783 @itemize @bullet
10784 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10785 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10786 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10787 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10788 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10789 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10790 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10791 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10792 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10793 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10794 shift data through vir can be configured.
10795 @end itemize
10796 @end deffn
10797
10798 Examples:
10799 @example
10800 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10801 @end example
10802 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10803 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10804
10805 @example
10806 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10807 @end example
10808 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10809 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10810
10811 @node Utility Commands
10812 @chapter Utility Commands
10813 @cindex Utility Commands
10814
10815 @section RAM testing
10816 @cindex RAM testing
10817
10818 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10819 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10820 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10821 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10822 hardware problems.
10823
10824 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10825 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10826 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10827 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10828
10829 Load the memory testing functions with
10830
10831 @example
10832 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10833 @end example
10834
10835 to get access to the following facilities:
10836
10837 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10838 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10839 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10840 @end deffn
10841
10842 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10843 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10844 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10845 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10846 @end deffn
10847
10848 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10849 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10850 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10851 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10852 @end deffn
10853
10854 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10855 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10856 @end deffn
10857
10858 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10859 @cindex Firmware recovery
10860
10861 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10862 devices recovery with JTAG.
10863
10864 For quickstart instructions run:
10865 @example
10866 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10867 @end example
10868
10869 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10870 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10871 @cindex GDB
10872 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10873 to debug remote targets.
10874 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10875
10876 @itemize
10877 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10878 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10879 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10880 as shown in this chapter.
10881 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10882 that also will probably need to be configured.
10883 @end itemize
10884
10885 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10886 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10887 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10888 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10889 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10890 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10891
10892 @section Connecting to GDB
10893 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10894 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10895 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10896 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10897 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10898
10899 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10900
10901 @enumerate
10902 @item
10903 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10904 @example
10905 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10906 @end example
10907 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10908
10909 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10910 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10911 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10912
10913 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10914 remote command above that becomes:
10915 @example
10916 tar ext :3333
10917 @end example
10918
10919 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10920 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10921 available through the command:
10922 @example
10923 target remote localhost:3333
10924 @end example
10925
10926 @item
10927 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10928 @example
10929 target extended-remote | \
10930 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10931 @end example
10932 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10933 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10934 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10935 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10936 @end enumerate
10937
10938 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10939 GDB command line.
10940
10941 @section Sample GDB session startup
10942
10943 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10944 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10945 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10946 small ARM program.
10947 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10948 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10949
10950 @example
10951 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10952 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10953 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10954 ...
10955 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10956 ...
10957 (gdb) load
10958 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10959 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10960 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10961 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10962 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10963 (gdb) continue
10964 Continuing.
10965 ...
10966 @end example
10967
10968 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10969 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10970 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10971 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10972
10973 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10974
10975 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10976 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10977 packet size and the device's memory map.
10978 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10979 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10980 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10981
10982 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10983 You may need to set those up by hand.
10984 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10985 something like:
10986
10987 @example
10988 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10989 @end example
10990
10991 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10992
10993 @example
10994 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10995 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10996 @end example
10997
10998 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10999 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11000 do not have such restrictions.
11001
11002 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11003 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11004 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11005 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11006
11007 @section Programming using GDB
11008 @cindex Programming using GDB
11009 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11010
11011 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11012 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11013 @example
11014 gdb_memory_map disable
11015 @end example
11016 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11017 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11018 working area.
11019
11020 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11021 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11022 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11023 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11024
11025 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11026 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11027
11028 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11029 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11030 @example
11031 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11032 @end example
11033
11034 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11035 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11036
11037 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11038 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11039 will be used.
11040
11041 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11042 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11043 @example
11044 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11045 @end example
11046 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11047
11048 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11049 can be used.
11050
11051 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11052 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11053 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11054
11055 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11056 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11057 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11058
11059 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11060 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11061 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11062 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11063 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11064 without any intrusion of the target process.
11065
11066 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11067 Place following command after target configuration:
11068 @example
11069 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11070 @end example
11071
11072 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11073 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11074 @example
11075 gdb_memory_map disable
11076 @end example
11077
11078 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11079 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11080 @example
11081 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11082 @end example
11083
11084 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11085 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11086
11087 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11088 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11089 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11090 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11091
11092 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11093 previously shown variables.
11094
11095 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11096 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11097 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11098 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11099 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11100
11101 @section RTOS Support
11102 @cindex RTOS Support
11103 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11104
11105 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11106 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11107
11108 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11109 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11110 GDB commands.
11111
11112 @* An example setup is below:
11113
11114 @example
11115 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11116 @end example
11117
11118 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11119
11120 Currently supported rtos's include:
11121 @itemize @bullet
11122 @item @option{eCos}
11123 @item @option{ThreadX}
11124 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11125 @item @option{linux}
11126 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11127 @item @option{embKernel}
11128 @item @option{mqx}
11129 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11130 @item @option{nuttx}
11131 @item @option{RIOT}
11132 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11133 @item @option{Zephyr}
11134 @end itemize
11135
11136 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11137 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11138
11139 @table @code
11140 @item eCos symbols
11141 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11142 @item ThreadX symbols
11143 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11144 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11145 @raggedright
11146 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11147 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11148 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11149 @end raggedright
11150 @item linux symbols
11151 init_task.
11152 @item ChibiOS symbols
11153 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11154 @item embKernel symbols
11155 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11156 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11157 @item mqx symbols
11158 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11159 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11160 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11161 @item nuttx symbols
11162 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11163 @item RIOT symbols
11164 @raggedright
11165 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11166 _tcb_name_offset.
11167 @end raggedright
11168 @item Zephyr symbols
11169 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11170 @end table
11171
11172 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11173 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11174
11175 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11176 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11177
11178 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11179 along with the project:
11180
11181 @table @code
11182 @item FreeRTOS
11183 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11184 @item uC/OS-III
11185 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11186 @end table
11187
11188 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11189 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11190 @cindex SMP
11191 @cindex RTOS
11192 @cindex hwthread
11193 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11194 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11195 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11196 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11197 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11198 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11199 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11200 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11201 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11202
11203 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11204 @quotation Note
11205 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11206 @end quotation
11207
11208 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11209 @itemize @bullet
11210 @item j - smp status request
11211 @item J - smp set request
11212 @end itemize
11213
11214 OpenOCD implements :
11215 @itemize @bullet
11216 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11217 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11218 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11219 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11220 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11221 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11222 @end itemize
11223
11224 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11225 @itemize @bullet
11226 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11227 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11228 @example
11229 set $_core 1
11230 #Jc01 packet is sent
11231 print $_core
11232 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11233 @end example
11234
11235 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11236 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11237
11238 @example
11239 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11240 define toggle0
11241 maint packet Jc0
11242 continue
11243 main packet Jc-1
11244 end
11245 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11246 define toggle1
11247 maint packet Jc1
11248 continue
11249 main packet Jc-1
11250 end
11251 @end example
11252 @end itemize
11253
11254 @node Tcl Scripting API
11255 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11256 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11257 @cindex Tcl scripts
11258 @section API rules
11259
11260 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11261 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11262 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11263
11264 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11265 pair list and lists.
11266
11267 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11268 list.
11269
11270 @example
11271 > set foo(me) Duane
11272 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11273 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11274 > set foo(duck) Donald
11275 @end example
11276
11277 If one does this:
11278
11279 @example
11280 > set foo
11281 @end example
11282
11283 The result is:
11284
11285 @example
11286 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11287 @end example
11288
11289 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11290
11291 @verbatim
11292 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11293 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11294 }
11295 @end verbatim
11296
11297 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11298 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11299
11300 @section Internal low-level Commands
11301
11302 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11303 invoke directly.
11304
11305 @itemize @bullet
11306 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11307
11308 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11309 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11310
11311 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11312 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11313
11314 Return information about the flash banks
11315
11316 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11317
11318 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11319 its execution. Example:
11320
11321 @example
11322 > capture "reset init"
11323 @end example
11324
11325 @end itemize
11326
11327 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11328 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11329 called "flash_banks".
11330
11331 @section Tcl RPC server
11332 @cindex RPC
11333
11334 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11335 commands and receive the results.
11336
11337 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11338 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11339 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11340 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11341 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11342
11343 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11344 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11345 @command{capture} command.
11346
11347 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11348
11349 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11350 @cindex RPC Notifications
11351
11352 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11353 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11354
11355 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11356 in the following format.
11357
11358 @verbatim
11359 type target_event event [event-name]
11360 type target_state state [state-name]
11361 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11362 @end verbatim
11363
11364 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11365 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11366 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11367 Defaults to off.
11368
11369 @end deffn
11370
11371 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11372 @cindex RPC trace output
11373
11374 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11375 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11376
11377 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11378
11379 @verbatim
11380 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11381 @end verbatim
11382
11383 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11384 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11385 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11386 Defaults to off.
11387
11388 See an example application here:
11389 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11390
11391 @end deffn
11392
11393 @node FAQ
11394 @chapter FAQ
11395 @cindex faq
11396 @enumerate
11397 @anchor{faqrtck}
11398 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11399 @cindex RTCK
11400 @cindex adaptive clocking
11401 @*
11402
11403 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11404 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11405 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11406 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11407
11408 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11409 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11410 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11411 @enumerate
11412 @item
11413 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11414 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11415 @item
11416 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11417 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11418 @end enumerate
11419
11420 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11421 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11422 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11423 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11424 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11425 power).
11426
11427 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11428 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11429 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11430 ARM926 scenario).
11431 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11432 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11433 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11434
11435 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11436 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11437 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11438 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11439
11440 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11441
11442 In order to make use of this,
11443 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11444 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11445
11446 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11447 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11448 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11449 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11450 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11451
11452 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11453 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11454 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11455 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11456
11457 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11458 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11459 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11460 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11461 with a CPLD.
11462 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11463 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11464 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11465 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11466 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11467 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11468
11469 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11470
11471 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11472
11473 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11474 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11475 depending on the chips on your board.
11476 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11477 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11478 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11479
11480 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11481 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11482 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11483
11484 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11485 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11486 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11487 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11488
11489 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11490 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11491 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11492 this way.
11493
11494 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11495 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11496 clock rate.
11497 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11498 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11499 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11500
11501 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11502
11503 @example
11504 # Example: 1.234MHz
11505 adapter speed 1234
11506 @end example
11507
11508
11509 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11510
11511 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11512 around Windows filenames.
11513
11514 @example
11515 > echo \a
11516
11517 > echo @{\a@}
11518 \a
11519 > echo "\a"
11520
11521 >
11522 @end example
11523
11524
11525 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11526
11527 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11528 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11529 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11530
11531 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11532 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11533 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11534
11535 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11536 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11537 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11538
11539 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11540
11541 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11542 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11543 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11544 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11545
11546 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11547 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11548 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11549
11550 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11551 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11552
11553 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11554 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11555 memory read caused data abort".
11556
11557 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11558 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11559 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11560 be done, feel free to add this here.
11561
11562 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11563 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11564 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11565 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11566 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11567 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11568 gracefully stops.
11569
11570 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11571 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11572 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11573
11574 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11575 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11576 bytes. Painful...
11577
11578
11579 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11580 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11581
11582 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11583 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11584 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11585 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11586 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11587 reset, everything else should work fine.
11588
11589 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11590 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11591 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11592 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11593
11594 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11595 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11596 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11597 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11598
11599 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11600
11601 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11602 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11603 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11604
11605 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11606 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11607
11608 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11609 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11610 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11611 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11612 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11613 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11614 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11615 clock frequency?
11616
11617 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11618 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11619 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11620 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11621 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11622
11623 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11624
11625 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11626 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11627 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11628 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11629 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11630 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11631 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11632
11633 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11634
11635 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11636 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11637 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11638 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11639
11640 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11641 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11642 particular order?
11643
11644 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11645 the same order used by the hardware.
11646
11647 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11648 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11649 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11650 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11651 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11652 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11653
11654 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11655 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11656 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11657 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11658
11659 @itemize @bullet
11660 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11661 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11662 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11663 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11664 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11665 @end itemize
11666
11667 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11668
11669 @itemize @bullet
11670 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11671 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11672 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11673 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11674 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11675 @end itemize
11676
11677
11678 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11679 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11680 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11681
11682 TODO.
11683
11684 @end enumerate
11685
11686 @node Tcl Crash Course
11687 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11688 @cindex Tcl
11689
11690 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11691 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11692 how the Tcl scripts work.
11693
11694 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11695 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11696 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11697 OpenOCD.
11698
11699 @section Tcl Rule #1
11700 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11701 @enumerate
11702 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11703 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11704 @end enumerate
11705
11706 The Tcl equal is this:
11707
11708 @enumerate
11709 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11710 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11711 @end enumerate
11712
11713 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11714 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11715
11716 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11717 There is a second pair of rules.
11718 @enumerate
11719 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11720 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11721 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11722 in Tcl.
11723 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11724 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11725 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11726 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11727 @end enumerate
11728
11729 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11730 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11731 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11732 Everything is a string}
11733
11734 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11735 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11736 difference is subtle.
11737 @enumerate
11738 @item Parse Time
11739 @item Evaluation Time
11740 @end enumerate
11741
11742 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11743 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11744 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11745
11746 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11747 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11748 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11749 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11750
11751 @itemize @bullet
11752 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11753 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11754 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11755 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11756 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11757 @example
11758 # bash example
11759 X=`date`
11760 echo "The Date is: $X"
11761 # Tcl example
11762 set X [date]
11763 puts "The Date is: $X"
11764 @end example
11765 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11766 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11767 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11768 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11769 is a string}
11770 @example
11771 set x "Dinner"
11772 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11773 @end example
11774 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11775 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11776 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11777 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11778 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11779 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11780 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11781 @end itemize
11782
11783 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11784
11785 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11786
11787 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11788
11789 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11790 the normal way.
11791
11792 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11793 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11794 line is immediately executed.
11795
11796 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11797 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11798
11799 @subsection Command Execution
11800
11801 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11802 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11803 control flow operators.
11804
11805 Commands are executed like this:
11806
11807 @enumerate
11808 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11809 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11810 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11811 @end enumerate
11812
11813 It sort of works like this:
11814 @example
11815 for(;;)@{
11816 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11817
11818 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11819
11820 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11821 @}
11822 @end example
11823
11824 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11825 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11826 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11827 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11828 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11829 ``LookupCommand()''
11830
11831 @subsection The FOR command
11832
11833 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11834 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11835 command just like any other command.
11836
11837 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11838 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11839 are:
11840
11841 @enumerate 0
11842 @item The ascii text 'for'
11843 @item The start text
11844 @item The test expression
11845 @item The next text
11846 @item The body text
11847 @end enumerate
11848
11849 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11850 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11851 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11852 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11853
11854 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11855 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11856
11857 @example
11858 int
11859 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11860 int *argc,
11861 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11862 @end example
11863
11864 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11865 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11866 still operates in the same basic way.
11867
11868 @subsection FOR command implementation
11869
11870 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11871 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11872
11873 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11874
11875 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11876
11877 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11878 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11879 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11880
11881 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11882 expression and returns a value.
11883
11884 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11885 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11886 @example
11887 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11888
11889 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11890
11891 int
11892 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11893 int argc,
11894 char **argv )
11895 @{
11896 if( argc != 5 )@{
11897 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11898 return ERROR;
11899 @}
11900
11901 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11902
11903 // Execute the start statement.
11904 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11905
11906 // Top of loop test
11907 for(;;)@{
11908 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11909 if( i == 0 )
11910 break;
11911
11912 // Execute the body
11913 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11914
11915 // Execute the LOOP part
11916 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11917 @}
11918
11919 // Return no error
11920 SetResult( interp, "" );
11921 return SUCCESS;
11922 @}
11923 @end example
11924
11925 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11926 in the same basic way.
11927
11928 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11929
11930 @subsection source and find commands
11931 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11932 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11933 @*Remember the parsing rules
11934 @enumerate
11935 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11936 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11937 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11938 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11939 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11940 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11941 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11942 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11943 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11944 @end enumerate
11945 @subsection format command
11946 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11947 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11948 @b{sprintf()}.
11949 @b{Example}
11950 @example
11951 set x 6
11952 set y 7
11953 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11954 @end example
11955 @enumerate
11956 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11957 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11958 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11959 @* Refer to Rule #1
11960 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11961 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11962 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11963 @end enumerate
11964 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11965 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11966 @example
11967 #1 Good
11968 proc someproc @{@} @{
11969 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11970 @}
11971 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11972 #2 Good - no variables
11973 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11974 #3 Good Curly Braces
11975 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11976 puts "Time: [date]"
11977 @}
11978 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11979 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11980 @end example
11981 @enumerate
11982 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11983 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11984 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11985 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11986 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11987 command.
11988 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11989 @*There are 4 examples:
11990 @enumerate
11991 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11992 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11993 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11994 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11995 @end enumerate
11996
11997 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11998 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11999 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12000
12001 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12002 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12003 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12004 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12005 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12006 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12007 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12008 @end enumerate
12009 @subsection Global Variables
12010 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12011 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12012 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12013 @example
12014 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12015 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12016 global x #Global variable X
12017 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12018 @}
12019 @end example
12020 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12021 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12022 @example
12023 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12024 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12025 # Create var name
12026 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12027 # Make it a global
12028 global $vn
12029 # Set it.
12030 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12031 @}
12032 @end example
12033 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12034 @example
12035 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12036 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12037 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12038 @}
12039 @end example
12040
12041 @node License
12042 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12043 @include fdl.texi
12044
12045 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12046 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12047 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12048 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12049 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12050 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12051
12052 @printindex cp
12053
12054 @node Command and Driver Index
12055 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12056 @printindex fn
12057
12058 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)